]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - ld/ld.texi
Update the documentation of the LINKER_VERSIOn script command to actually mention...
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-linker-version
465 @item --enable-linker-version
466 Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467 in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468 script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469 linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471 Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472 significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473 the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475 @kindex --disable-linker-version
476 @item --disable-linker-version
477 Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478 does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
480 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490 @smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509 @end smallexample
510
511 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516 This option enables warnings when
517 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520 output region.
521
522 @cindex entry point, from command line
523 @kindex -e @var{entry}
524 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
525 @item -e @var{entry}
526 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
535 @kindex --exclude-libs
536 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
538 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
539 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544 be treated as hidden.
545
546 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557 regardless of this option.
558
559 @cindex dynamic symbol table
560 @kindex -E
561 @kindex --export-dynamic
562 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
563 @item -E
564 @itemx --export-dynamic
565 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
566 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
575
576 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579 linking the program itself.
580
581 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
582 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
583 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
584
585 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
589 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590 @cindex export dynamic symbol
591 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
602 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
607 @ifclear SingleFormat
608 @cindex big-endian objects
609 @cindex endianness
610 @kindex -EB
611 @item -EB
612 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614 @cindex little-endian objects
615 @kindex -EL
616 @item -EL
617 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
618 @end ifclear
619
620 @kindex -f @var{name}
621 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622 @item -f @var{name}
623 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
624 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
637 machine-specific performance.
638
639 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
642 @kindex -F @var{name}
643 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
644 @item -F @var{name}
645 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
646 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657 @var{name}.
658
659 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
660 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
661 object files.
662 @ifclear SingleFormat
663 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
664 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
665 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
666 environment variable.
667 @end ifclear
668 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669 creating an ELF shared object.
670
671 @cindex finalization function
672 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
673 @item -fini=@var{name}
674 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677 the function to call.
678
679 @kindex -g
680 @item -g
681 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
683 @kindex -G @var{value}
684 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
685 @cindex object size
686 @item -G @var{value}
687 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
690 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
691 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693 @cindex runtime library name
694 @kindex -h @var{name}
695 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
696 @item -h @var{name}
697 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
698 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
702 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
703
704 @kindex -i
705 @cindex incremental link
706 @item -i
707 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
709 @cindex initialization function
710 @kindex -init=@var{name}
711 @item -init=@var{name}
712 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715 function to call.
716
717 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
718 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
719 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
720 @item -l @var{namespec}
721 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
725 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
726 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
727
728 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
729 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735 @var{filename}.
736
737 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
744 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
745 archives multiple times.
746
747 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749 @ifset GENERIC
750 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
751 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
752 behaviour of the AIX linker.
753 @end ifset
754
755 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
756 @kindex -L @var{dir}
757 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
758 @item -L @var{searchdir}
759 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
760 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
762 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
765 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
766 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768 option is specified.
769
770 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
773
774 @ifset UsesEnvVars
775 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
776 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
777 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778 @end ifset
779
780 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784 @cindex emulation
785 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
786 @item -m @var{emulation}
787 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794 configured.
795
796 @cindex remapping inputs
797 @kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798 @kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799 @item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800 @itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801 These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802 linker attempts to open them. The option
803 @option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804 file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805 @file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806 so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807 matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809 An alternative form of the option
810 @option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811 from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812 Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813 the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814 The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815 or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817 The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818 accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819 they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820 order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821 checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823 If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824 then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825 This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826 from a complicated build environment.
827
828 Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829 that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831 @smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833 @end smallexample
834
835 Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837 @smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839 @end smallexample
840
841 Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843 Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844 statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845 after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846 options on the command line is not significant.
847
848 If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849 will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850 be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851 appear.
852
853 If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854 the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
856 @cindex link map
857 @kindex -M
858 @kindex --print-map
859 @item -M
860 @itemx --print-map
861 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862 information about the link, including the following:
863
864 @itemize @bullet
865 @item
866 Where object files are mapped into memory.
867 @item
868 How common symbols are allocated.
869 @item
870 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
872 @item
873 The values assigned to symbols.
874
875 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881 linker script containing:
882
883 @smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887 @end smallexample
888
889 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890 option is used:
891
892 @smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896 @end smallexample
897
898 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899 scripts.
900
901 @item
902 How GNU properties are merged.
903
904 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
907
908 @smallexample
909 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910 @end smallexample
911
912 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
913 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916 @smallexample
917 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
918 @end smallexample
919
920 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
921 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
923 @end itemize
924
925 @cindex link map discarded
926 @kindex --print-map-discarded
927 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928 @item --print-map-discarded
929 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931 in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
933 @kindex --print-map-locals
934 @kindex --no-print-map-locals
935 @item --print-map-locals
936 @itemx --no-print-map-locals
937 Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938 will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939 be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940 Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941 will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
943 @kindex -n
944 @cindex read-only text
945 @cindex NMAGIC
946 @kindex --nmagic
947 @item -n
948 @itemx --nmagic
949 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
952
953 @kindex -N
954 @kindex --omagic
955 @cindex read/write from cmd line
956 @cindex OMAGIC
957 @item -N
958 @itemx --omagic
959 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
960 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
962 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964 specification published by Microsoft.
965
966 @kindex --no-omagic
967 @cindex OMAGIC
968 @item --no-omagic
969 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
973
974 @kindex -o @var{output}
975 @kindex --output=@var{output}
976 @cindex naming the output file
977 @item -o @var{output}
978 @itemx --output=@var{output}
979 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
980 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
983 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984 @cindex dependency file
985 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
998 @kindex -O @var{level}
999 @cindex generating optimized output
1000 @item -O @var{level}
1001 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
1002 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
1003 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
1008
1009 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010 @item -plugin @var{name}
1011 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015 wish.
1016
1017 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
1021 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
1022 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
1023 just copy in the newest one.
1024
1025 @kindex --push-state
1026 @cindex push state governing input file handling
1027 @item --push-state
1028 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
1029 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042 something as follows:
1043
1044 @smallexample
1045 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046 @end smallexample
1047
1048 @kindex --pop-state
1049 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
1050 @item --pop-state
1051 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052 flags governing input file handling.
1053
1054 @kindex -q
1055 @kindex --emit-relocs
1056 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057 @item -q
1058 @itemx --emit-relocs
1059 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
1060 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062 in larger executables.
1063
1064 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
1066 @kindex --force-dynamic
1067 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068 @item --force-dynamic
1069 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070 to VxWorks targets.
1071
1072 @cindex partial link
1073 @cindex relocatable output
1074 @kindex -r
1075 @kindex --relocatable
1076 @item -r
1077 @itemx --relocatable
1078 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
1079 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
1080 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082 @code{OMAGIC}.
1083 @c ; see @option{-N}.
1084 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
1088 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092 with input files in other formats at all.
1093
1094 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096 @kindex -R @var{file}
1097 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098 @cindex symbol-only input
1099 @item -R @var{filename}
1100 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
1106 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1107 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1108 the @option{-rpath} option.
1109
1110 @kindex -s
1111 @kindex --strip-all
1112 @cindex strip all symbols
1113 @item -s
1114 @itemx --strip-all
1115 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117 @kindex -S
1118 @kindex --strip-debug
1119 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1120 @item -S
1121 @itemx --strip-debug
1122 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
1124 @kindex --strip-discarded
1125 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126 @item --strip-discarded
1127 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129 Enabled by default.
1130
1131 @kindex -t
1132 @kindex --trace
1133 @cindex input files, displaying
1134 @item -t
1135 @itemx --trace
1136 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140 a linker bug report.
1141
1142 @kindex -T @var{script}
1143 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1144 @cindex script files
1145 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1148 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149 unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
1150 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1151 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154 options accumulate.
1155
1156 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1157 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158 @cindex script files
1159 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170 @samp{gcc}).
1171
1172 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174 @cindex undefined symbol
1175 @item -u @var{symbol}
1176 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
1183 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186 instead.
1187
1188 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189 @cindex symbols, require defined
1190 @cindex defined symbol
1191 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
1199 @kindex -Ur
1200 @cindex constructors
1201 @item -Ur
1202
1203 For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204 based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205 relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206 input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207 option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208 constructors and destructors.
1209
1210 For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211 differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212 themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213 been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214 partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
1215
1216 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217 @cindex orphan sections
1218 @cindex sections, orphan
1219 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225 @table @code
1226 @item place
1227 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1229 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1230
1231 @item discard
1232 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235 @item warn
1236 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237 issue a warning.
1238
1239 @item error
1240 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241 @end table
1242
1243 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
1245 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253 in a linker script.
1254
1255 @kindex -v
1256 @kindex -V
1257 @kindex --version
1258 @cindex version
1259 @item -v
1260 @itemx --version
1261 @itemx -V
1262 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1263 lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264 @option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265 which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
1266
1267 @kindex -x
1268 @kindex --discard-all
1269 @cindex deleting local symbols
1270 @item -x
1271 @itemx --discard-all
1272 Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274 @kindex -X
1275 @kindex --discard-locals
1276 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1277 @item -X
1278 @itemx --discard-locals
1279 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1282
1283 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285 @cindex symbol tracing
1286 @item -y @var{symbol}
1287 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290 to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1296 @item -Y @var{path}
1297 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298 for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301 @item -z @var{keyword}
1302 The recognized keywords are:
1303 @table @samp
1304
1305 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
1317 @item cet-report=none
1318 @itemx cet-report=warning
1319 @itemx cet-report=error
1320 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
1332 @item combreloc
1333 @itemx nocombreloc
1334 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1336
1337 @item common
1338 @itemx nocommon
1339 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345 using pages of this size.
1346
1347 @item defs
1348 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1351
1352 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360 these options.
1361
1362 @item execstack
1363 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
1365 @item global
1366 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
1370 @item globalaudit
1371 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1375 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1376 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1377
1378 @item ibtplt
1379 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
1382 @item ibt
1383 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
1387 @item indirect-extern-access
1388 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397 section.
1398
1399 @item initfirst
1400 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405 objects.
1406
1407 @item interpose
1408 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410 libraries not so marked.
1411
1412 @item unique
1413 @itemx nounique
1414 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
1422 @item lam-u48
1423 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426 @item lam-u57
1427 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430 @item lam-u48-report=none
1431 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442 @item lam-u57-report=none
1443 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454 @item lam-report=none
1455 @itemx lam-report=warning
1456 @itemx lam-report=error
1457 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
1466 @item lazy
1467 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470 Lazy binding is the default.
1471
1472 @item loadfltr
1473 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1474
1475 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1477
1478 @item mark-plt
1479 @itemx nomark-plt
1480 Mark PLT entries with dynamic tags, DT_X86_64_PLT, DT_X86_64_PLTSZ and
1481 DT_X86_64_PLTENT. Since this option stores a non-zero value in the
1482 r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, the resulting
1483 executables and shared libraries are incompatible with dynamic linkers,
1484 such as those in older versions of glibc without the change to ignore
1485 r_addend in R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT and R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, which
1486 don't ignore the r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations.
1487 Supported for x86_64.
1488
1489 @item muldefs
1490 Allow multiple definitions.
1491
1492 @item nocopyreloc
1493 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1494 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1495
1496 @item nodefaultlib
1497 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1498 should ignore any default library search paths.
1499
1500 @item nodelete
1501 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1502
1503 @item nodlopen
1504 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1505
1506 @item nodump
1507 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1508
1509 @item noexecstack
1510 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1511
1512 @item noextern-protected-data
1513 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1514 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1515 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1516 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1517 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1518 i386 and x86-64.
1519
1520 @item noreloc-overflow
1521 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1522 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1523 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1524
1525 @item now
1526 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1527 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1528 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1529 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1530 called.
1531
1532 @item origin
1533 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1534
1535 @item pack-relative-relocs
1536 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1537 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1538 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1539 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1540 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1541 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1542 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1543 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1544 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1545
1546 @item relro
1547 @itemx norelro
1548 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1549 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1550 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1551 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1552 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1553
1554 @item report-relative-reloc
1555 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1556 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1557
1558 @item sectionheader
1559 @itemx nosectionheader
1560 Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1561 @samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1562
1563 @item separate-code
1564 @itemx noseparate-code
1565 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1566 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1567 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1568 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1569
1570 @item shstk
1571 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1572 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1573 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1574
1575 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1576 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1577 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1578 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1579
1580 @item start-stop-gc
1581 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1582 @cindex start-stop-gc
1583 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1584 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1585 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1586 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1587 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1588 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1589 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1590 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1591 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1592 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1593 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1594 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1595 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1596
1597 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1598 @cindex visibility
1599 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1600 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1601 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1602 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1603 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1604 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1605 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1606 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1607 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1608 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1609
1610 @item text
1611 @itemx notext
1612 @itemx textoff
1613 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1614 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1615 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1616
1617 @item undefs
1618 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1619 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1620 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1621
1622 @item unique-symbol
1623 @itemx nounique-symbol
1624 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1625 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1626 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1627
1628 @item x86-64-baseline
1629 @item x86-64-v2
1630 @item x86-64-v3
1631 @itemx x86-64-v4
1632 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1633 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1634 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1635 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1636 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1637 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1638
1639 @end table
1640
1641 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1642
1643 @kindex -(
1644 @cindex groups of archives
1645 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1646 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1647 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1648 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1649
1650 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1651 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1652 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1653 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1654 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1655 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1656 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1657 resolved.
1658
1659 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1660 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1661 more archives.
1662
1663 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1664 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1665 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1666 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1667 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1668 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1669 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1670 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1671 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1672 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1673 restore the old behaviour.
1674
1675 @kindex --as-needed
1676 @kindex --no-as-needed
1677 @item --as-needed
1678 @itemx --no-as-needed
1679 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1680 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1681 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1682 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1683 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1684 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1685 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1686 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1687 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1688 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1689 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1690 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1691 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1692
1693 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1694 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1695 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1696 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1697
1698 @kindex --add-needed
1699 @kindex --no-add-needed
1700 @item --add-needed
1701 @itemx --no-add-needed
1702 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1703 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1704 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1705 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1706
1707 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1708 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1709 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1710
1711 @kindex -Bdynamic
1712 @kindex -dy
1713 @kindex -call_shared
1714 @item -Bdynamic
1715 @itemx -dy
1716 @itemx -call_shared
1717 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1718 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1719 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1720 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1721 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1722 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1723
1724 @kindex -Bgroup
1725 @item -Bgroup
1726 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1727 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1728 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1729 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1730 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1731
1732 @kindex -Bstatic
1733 @kindex -dn
1734 @kindex -non_shared
1735 @kindex -static
1736 @item -Bstatic
1737 @itemx -dn
1738 @itemx -non_shared
1739 @itemx -static
1740 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1741 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1742 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1743 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1744 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1745 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1746 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1747 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1748 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1749 libraries.
1750
1751 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1752 @item -Bsymbolic
1753 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1754 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1755 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1756 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1757 platforms which support shared libraries.
1758
1759 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1760 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1761 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1762 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1763 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1764 libraries.
1765
1766 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1767 @item -Bno-symbolic
1768 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1769 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1770
1771 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1772 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1773 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1774 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1775 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1776 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1777 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1778 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1779 which support shared libraries.
1780
1781 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1782 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1783
1784 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1785 @item --dynamic-list-data
1786 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1787
1788 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1789 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1790 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1791 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1792
1793 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1794 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1795 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1796
1797 @kindex --check-sections
1798 @kindex --no-check-sections
1799 @item --check-sections
1800 @itemx --no-check-sections
1801 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1802 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1803 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1804 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1805 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1806 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1807 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1808 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1809 option.
1810
1811 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1812 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1813 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1814 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1815 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1816 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1817 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1818 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1819 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1820 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1821 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1822 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1823
1824 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1825 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1826 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1827 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1828 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1829 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1830 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1831 symbols.
1832
1833 @cindex cross reference table
1834 @kindex --cref
1835 @item --cref
1836 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1837 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1838 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1839
1840 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1841 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1842 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1843 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1844 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1845 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1846 symbol are listed.
1847
1848 @cindex ctf variables
1849 @kindex --ctf-variables
1850 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1851 @item --ctf-variables
1852 @item --no-ctf-variables
1853 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1854 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1855 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1856 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1857 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1858 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1859 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1860
1861 @cindex ctf type sharing
1862 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1863 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1864 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1865
1866 @table @samp
1867 @item share-unconflicted
1868 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1869 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1870 translation unit. This is the default.
1871
1872 @item share-duplicated
1873 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1874 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1875 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1876 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1877 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1878 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1879 consumer at runtime.
1880 @end table
1881
1882 @cindex common allocation
1883 @kindex --no-define-common
1884 @item --no-define-common
1885 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1886 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1887 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1888
1889 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1890 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1891 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1892 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1893 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1894 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1895 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1896 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1897 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1898 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1899
1900 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1901 @cindex section groups
1902 @cindex COMDAT
1903 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1904 @item --force-group-allocation
1905 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1906 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1907 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1908 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1909 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1910 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1911
1912 @cindex symbols, from command line
1913 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1914 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1915 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1916 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1917 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1918 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1919 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1920 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1921 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1922 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1923 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1924 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1925
1926 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1927 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1928 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1929 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1930 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1931 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1932 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1933 you are trying to achieve.
1934
1935 @cindex demangling, from command line
1936 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1937 @kindex --no-demangle
1938 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1939 @itemx --no-demangle
1940 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1941 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1942 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1943 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1944 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1945 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1946 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1947 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1948 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1949
1950 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1951 @kindex -I@var{file}
1952 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1953 @item -I@var{file}
1954 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1955 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1956 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1957 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1958 doing.
1959
1960 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1961 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1962 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1963 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1964 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1965 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1966
1967 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1968 @item --embedded-relocs
1969 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1970 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1971 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1972 targets.
1973
1974 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1975 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1976 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1977 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1978
1979 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1980 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1981 @item --fatal-warnings
1982 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1983 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1984 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1985
1986 @kindex -w
1987 @kindex --no-warnings
1988 @item -w
1989 @itemx --no-warnings
1990 Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1991 @option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1992 used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1993 is still a need to create it.
1994
1995 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1996 @item --force-exe-suffix
1997 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1998
1999 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
2000 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
2001 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
2002 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
2003 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
2004 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
2005
2006 @kindex --gc-sections
2007 @kindex --no-gc-sections
2008 @cindex garbage collection
2009 @item --gc-sections
2010 @itemx --no-gc-sections
2011 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
2012 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
2013 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
2014 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2015 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2016 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
2017
2018 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2019 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2020 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2021 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2022 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2023 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2024 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2025 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
2026 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2027 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
2028
2029 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
2030 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
2031 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2032 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2033 command in the linker script.
2034
2035 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2036 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2037
2038 @kindex --print-gc-sections
2039 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2040 @cindex garbage collection
2041 @item --print-gc-sections
2042 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2043 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2044 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2045 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2046 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2047 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2048 line.
2049
2050 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
2051 @cindex garbage collection
2052 @item --gc-keep-exported
2053 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2054 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2055 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2056 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2057 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2058 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2059 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2060 ELF format targets.
2061
2062 @kindex --print-output-format
2063 @cindex output format
2064 @item --print-output-format
2065 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2066 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2067 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2068
2069 @kindex --print-memory-usage
2070 @cindex memory usage
2071 @item --print-memory-usage
2072 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2073 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2074 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2075 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2076 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2080 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2081 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2082 @end smallexample
2083
2084 @cindex help
2085 @cindex usage
2086 @kindex --help
2087 @item --help
2088 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2089
2090 @kindex --target-help
2091 @item --target-help
2092 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
2093
2094 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2095 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
2096 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2097 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2098 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2099
2100 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2101 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2102 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2103 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2104 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2105 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2106 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2107
2108 @smallexample
2109 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2110 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2111 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2112 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2113 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2114 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2115 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2116 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2117 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2118 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2119 @end smallexample
2120
2121 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2122
2123 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2124 operation.
2125
2126 @cindex memory usage
2127 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2128 @item --no-keep-memory
2129 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2130 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2131 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2132 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2133 while linking a large executable.
2134
2135 @kindex --no-undefined
2136 @kindex -z defs
2137 @kindex -z undefs
2138 @item --no-undefined
2139 @itemx -z defs
2140 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2141 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2142 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2143 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2144 libraries being linked in.
2145
2146 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2147
2148 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2149 @kindex -z muldefs
2150 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2151 @itemx -z muldefs
2152 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2153 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2154 first definition will be used.
2155
2156 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2157 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2158 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2159 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2160 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2161 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2162 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2163 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2164 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2165
2166 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2167 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2168 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2169 a shared library.
2170
2171 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2172 libraries specified at link time are that:
2173
2174 @itemize @bullet
2175 @item
2176 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2177 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2178 resolvable at load time.
2179 @item
2180 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2181 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2182
2183 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2184 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2185 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2186 appropriate memset function.
2187 @end itemize
2188
2189 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2190 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2191 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2192 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2193 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2194 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2195 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2196 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2197 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2198 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2199 error message will be displayed.
2200
2201 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2202 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2203
2204 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2205 @item --no-undefined-version
2206 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2207 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2208 will be issued instead.
2209
2210 @kindex --default-symver
2211 @item --default-symver
2212 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2213 exported symbols.
2214
2215 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2216 @item --default-imported-symver
2217 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2218 imported symbols.
2219
2220 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2221 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2222 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2223 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2224 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2225 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2226 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2227 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2228 inappropriate.
2229
2230 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2231 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2232 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2233 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2234
2235 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2236 @item --no-whole-archive
2237 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2238 archive files.
2239
2240 @cindex output file after errors
2241 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2242 @item --noinhibit-exec
2243 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2244 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2245 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2246 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2247
2248 @kindex -nostdlib
2249 @item -nostdlib
2250 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2251 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2252 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2253
2254 @ifclear SingleFormat
2255 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2256 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2257 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2258 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2259 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2260 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2261 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2262 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2263 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2264 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2265 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2266 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2267 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2268 @end ifclear
2269
2270 @kindex --out-implib
2271 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2272 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2273 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2274 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2275 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2276 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2277 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2278 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2279
2280 @kindex -pie
2281 @kindex --pic-executable
2282 @item -pie
2283 @itemx --pic-executable
2284 @cindex position independent executables
2285 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2286 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2287 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2288 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2289 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2290 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2291
2292 @kindex -no-pie
2293 @item -no-pie
2294 @cindex position dependent executables
2295 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2296
2297 @kindex -qmagic
2298 @item -qmagic
2299 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2300
2301 @kindex -Qy
2302 @item -Qy
2303 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2304
2305 @kindex --relax
2306 @cindex synthesizing linker
2307 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2308 @cindex --no-relax
2309 @item --relax
2310 @itemx --no-relax
2311 An option with machine dependent effects.
2312 @ifset GENERIC
2313 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2314 @end ifset
2315 @ifset H8300
2316 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2317 @end ifset
2318 @ifset XTENSA
2319 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2320 @end ifset
2321 @ifset M68HC11
2322 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2323 @end ifset
2324 @ifset NIOSII
2325 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2326 @end ifset
2327 @ifset POWERPC
2328 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2329 @end ifset
2330
2331 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2332 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2333 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2334 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2335 instructions, and combining constant values.
2336
2337 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2338 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2339 @ifset GENERIC
2340 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2341 family of processors.
2342 @end ifset
2343
2344 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2345 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2346
2347 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2348 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2349
2350 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2351 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2352 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2353 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2354 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2355 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2356 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2357 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2358 @ifset GENERIC
2359 (such as VxWorks)
2360 @end ifset
2361 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2362 run-time memory.
2363
2364 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2365 or symbols needed for relocations.
2366
2367 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2368 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2369
2370 @ifset GENERIC
2371 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2372 @cindex runtime library search path
2373 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2374 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2375 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2376 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2377 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2378
2379 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2380 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2381 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2382 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2383 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2384
2385 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2386 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2387 is defined.
2388
2389 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2390 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2391 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2392 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2393 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2394 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2395 file systems.
2396
2397 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2398 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2399 the @option{-rpath} option.
2400 @end ifset
2401
2402 @ifset GENERIC
2403 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2404 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2405 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2406 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2407 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2408 of the input files.
2409
2410 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2411 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2412 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2413 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2414 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2415 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2416 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2417 appearing multiple times.
2418
2419 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2420 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2421 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2422 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2423 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2424
2425 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2426 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2427 supported.
2428
2429 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2430 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2431 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2432 runtime linker would do.
2433
2434 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2435 libraries:
2436
2437 @enumerate
2438 @item
2439 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2440 @item
2441 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2442 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2443 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2444 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2445 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2446 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2447 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2448 @item
2449 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2450 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2451 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2452 @item
2453 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2454 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2455 @item
2456 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2457 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2458 @item
2459 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2460 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2461 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2462 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2463 @item
2464 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2465 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2466 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2467 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2468 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2469 @item
2470 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2471 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2472 header file.
2473 @item
2474 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2475 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2476 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2477 @item
2478 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2479 @item
2480 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2481 @item
2482 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2483 linker script.
2484 @end enumerate
2485
2486 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2487 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2488 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2489 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2490 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2491 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2492 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2493 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2494 of the first.
2495
2496 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2497 warning and continue with the link.
2498
2499 @end ifset
2500
2501 @kindex -shared
2502 @kindex -Bshareable
2503 @item -shared
2504 @itemx -Bshareable
2505 @cindex shared libraries
2506 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2507 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2508 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2509 undefined symbols in the link.
2510
2511 @kindex --sort-common
2512 @item --sort-common
2513 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2514 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2515 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2516 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2517 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2518 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2519 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2520 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2521
2522 @kindex --sort-section=name
2523 @item --sort-section=name
2524 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2525 patterns in the linker script.
2526
2527 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2528 @item --sort-section=alignment
2529 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2530 patterns in the linker script.
2531
2532 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2533 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2534 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2535 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2536 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2537
2538 @kindex --split-by-file
2539 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2540 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2541 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2542 size of 1 if not given.
2543
2544 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2545 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2546 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2547 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2548 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2549 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2550 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2551 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2552 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2553 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2554 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2555 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2556
2557 @kindex --stats
2558 @item --stats
2559 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2560 as execution time and memory usage.
2561
2562 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2563 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2564 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2565 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2566 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2567
2568 @kindex --task-link
2569 @item --task-link
2570 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2571 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2572
2573 @kindex --traditional-format
2574 @cindex traditional format
2575 @item --traditional-format
2576 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2577 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2578 use the traditional format instead.
2579
2580 @cindex dbx
2581 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2582 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2583 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2584 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2585 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2586 combine duplicate entries.
2587
2588 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2589 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2590 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2591 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2592 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2593 line.
2594 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2595 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2596 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2597 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2598 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2599
2600 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2601 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2602 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2603 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2604 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2605 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2606 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2607 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2608 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2609
2610 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2611 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2612 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2613 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2614 byte of the text segment.
2615
2616 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2617 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2618 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2619 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2620 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2621 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2622
2623 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2624 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2625 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2626 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2627 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2628
2629 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2630 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2631 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2632 values for @samp{method}:
2633
2634 @table @samp
2635 @item ignore-all
2636 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2637
2638 @item report-all
2639 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2640
2641 @item ignore-in-object-files
2642 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2643 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2644
2645 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2646 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2647 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2648 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2649 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2650 command line.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2654 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2655
2656 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2657 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2658 can change this to a warning.
2659
2660 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2661 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2662 @item --dll-verbose
2663 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2664 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2665 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2666 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2667 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2668
2669 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2670 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2671 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2672 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2673 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2674 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2675 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2676 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2677 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2678 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2679 @xref{WIN32}.
2680
2681 @kindex --warn-common
2682 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2683 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2684 @item --warn-common
2685 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2686 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2687 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2688 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2689 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2690 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2691
2692 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2693
2694 @table @samp
2695 @item int i = 1;
2696 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2697 file.
2698
2699 @item extern int i;
2700 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2701 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2702 variable somewhere.
2703
2704 @item int i;
2705 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2706 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2707 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2708 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2709 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2710 a definition of the same variable.
2711 @end table
2712
2713 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2714 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2715 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2716 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2717 a common symbol.
2718
2719 @enumerate
2720 @item
2721 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2722 definition for the symbol.
2723 @smallexample
2724 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2725 overridden by definition
2726 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2727 @end smallexample
2728
2729 @item
2730 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2731 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2732 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2733 @smallexample
2734 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2735 overriding common
2736 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2737 @end smallexample
2738
2739 @item
2740 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2741 @smallexample
2742 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2743 of `@var{symbol}'
2744 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 @item
2748 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2749 @smallexample
2750 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2751 overridden by larger common
2752 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2753 @end smallexample
2754
2755 @item
2756 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2757 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2758 encountered in a different order.
2759 @smallexample
2760 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2761 overriding smaller common
2762 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2763 @end smallexample
2764 @end enumerate
2765
2766 @kindex --warn-constructors
2767 @item --warn-constructors
2768 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2769 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2770 detect the use of global constructors.
2771
2772 @kindex --warn-execstack
2773 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2774 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2775 @item --warn-execstack
2776 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2777 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2778 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2779 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2780 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2781 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2782
2783 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2784 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2785 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2786 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2787 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2788
2789 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2790 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2791 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2792 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2793 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2794 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2795 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2796 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2797 crafted assembler files.
2798
2799 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2800 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2801 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2802 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2803 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2804 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2805 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2806 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2807 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2808 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2809 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2810 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2811 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2812
2813 @kindex --warn-once
2814 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2815 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2816 @item --warn-once
2817 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2818 which refers to it.
2819
2820 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2821 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2822 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2823 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2824 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2825 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2826 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2827 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2828 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2829 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2830 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2831
2832 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2833 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2834 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2835
2836 @kindex --warn-section-align
2837 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2838 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2839 @item --warn-section-align
2840 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2841 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2842 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2843 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2844 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2845
2846 @kindex --warn-textrel
2847 @item --warn-textrel
2848 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2849 or shared object.
2850
2851 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2852 @item --warn-alternate-em
2853 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2854
2855 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2856 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2857 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2858 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2859 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2860
2861 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2862 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2863 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2864 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2865
2866 @kindex --whole-archive
2867 @cindex including an entire archive
2868 @item --whole-archive
2869 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2870 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2871 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2872 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2873 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2874 library. This option may be used more than once.
2875
2876 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2877 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2878 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2879 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2880 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2881
2882 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2883 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2884 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2885 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2886 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2887 @var{symbol}.
2888
2889 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2890 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2891 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2892 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2893
2894 Here is a trivial example:
2895
2896 @smallexample
2897 void *
2898 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2899 @{
2900 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2901 return __real_malloc (c);
2902 @}
2903 @end smallexample
2904
2905 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2906 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2907 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2908 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2909
2910 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2911 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2912 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2913 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2914 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2915
2916 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2917 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2918 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2919 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2920
2921 @smallexample
2922 int
2923 f (void)
2924 @{
2925 return 123;
2926 @}
2927
2928 int
2929 g (void)
2930 @{
2931 return f();
2932 @}
2933 @end smallexample
2934
2935 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2936 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2937 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2938 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2939 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2940 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2941 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2942
2943 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2944 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2945 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2946 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2947 if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
2948 controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
2949 generated code sections like PLT.
2950
2951 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2952 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2953 @item --enable-new-dtags
2954 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2955 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2956 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2957 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2958 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2959 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2960 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2961 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2962
2963 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2964 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2965 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2966 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2967 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2968 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2969 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2970
2971 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2972 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2973 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2974 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2975 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2976 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2977 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2978 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2979
2980 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2981 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2982 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2983 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2984 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2985 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2986 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2987 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2988 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2989 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
2990 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2991 compressed using zlib.
2992
2993 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2994 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2995 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2996 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2997 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2998 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2999
3000 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
3001 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
3002
3003 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
3004 zstd.
3005
3006 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
3007 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
3008 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
3009 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
3010
3011 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3012 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3013 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3014 @option{--help} option.
3015
3016 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3017 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
3018 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
3019 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
3020 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
3021 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3022
3023 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
3024 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
3025 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
3026 has been used.
3027
3028 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3029 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
3030
3031 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3032 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3033 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3034 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3035 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3036
3037 @kindex --build-id
3038 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3039 @item --build-id
3040 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
3041 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
3042 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
3043 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3044 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3045 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3046 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3047 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3048 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3049 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3050 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
3051
3052 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3053 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3054 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3055 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3056 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3057 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
3058
3059 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3060 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
3061
3062 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3063 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3064 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3065 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3066 specification. For more information see:
3067 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3068 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3069 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3070 occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
3071 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3072 will be validated.
3073 @end table
3074
3075 @c man end
3076
3077 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
3078
3079 @c man begin OPTIONS
3080
3081 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
3082 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3083 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3084 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3085 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3086 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3087 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3088 object file).
3089
3090 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
3091 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
3092 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3093 values by either a space or an equals sign.
3094
3095 @table @gcctabopt
3096
3097 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3098 @item --add-stdcall-alias
3099 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3100 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
3101 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3102
3103 @kindex --base-file
3104 @item --base-file @var{file}
3105 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3106 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3107 @file{dlltool}.
3108 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
3109
3110 @kindex --dll
3111 @item --dll
3112 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
3113 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
3114 file.
3115 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3116
3117 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
3118 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
3119 @item --enable-long-section-names
3120 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
3121 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
3122 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3123 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3124 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3125 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3126 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3127 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3128 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3129 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3130 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3131 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3132 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3133 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3134 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3135 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3136 image and not stripping symbols.
3137 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3138
3139 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3140 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3141 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3142 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3143 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3144 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3145 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3146 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3147 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3148 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3149 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3150 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3151 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3152 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3153 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3154 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3155 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3156 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3157
3158 @kindex --leading-underscore
3159 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3160 @item --leading-underscore
3161 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3162 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3163 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3164 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3165
3166 @cindex DLLs, creating
3167 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3168 @item --export-all-symbols
3169 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3170 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3171 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3172 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3173 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3174 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3175 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3176 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3177 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3178 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3179 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3180 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3181 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3182 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3183 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3184 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3185 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3186 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3187 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3188 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3189 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3190 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3191 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3192
3193 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3194 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3195 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3196 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3197 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3198
3199 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3200 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3201 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3202 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3203
3204 @kindex --file-alignment
3205 @item --file-alignment
3206 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3207 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3208 512.
3209 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3210
3211 @cindex heap size
3212 @kindex --heap
3213 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3214 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3215 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3216 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3217 committed.
3218 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3219
3220 @cindex image base
3221 @kindex --image-base
3222 @item --image-base @var{value}
3223 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3224 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3225 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3226 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3227 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3228 for dlls.
3229 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3230
3231 @kindex --kill-at
3232 @item --kill-at
3233 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3234 symbols before they are exported.
3235 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3236
3237 @kindex --large-address-aware
3238 @item --large-address-aware
3239 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3240 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3241 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3242 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3243 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3244 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3245
3246 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3247 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3248 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3249 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3250 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3251 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3252 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3253
3254 @kindex --major-image-version
3255 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3256 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3257 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3258
3259 @kindex --major-os-version
3260 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3261 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3262 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3263
3264 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3265 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3266 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3267 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3268
3269 @kindex --minor-image-version
3270 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3271 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3272 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3273
3274 @kindex --minor-os-version
3275 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3276 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3277 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3278
3279 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3280 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3281 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3282 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3283
3284 @cindex DEF files, creating
3285 @cindex DLLs, creating
3286 @kindex --output-def
3287 @item --output-def @var{file}
3288 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3289 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3290 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3291 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3292 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3293 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3294
3295 @cindex DLLs, creating
3296 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3297 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3298 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3299 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3300 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3301 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3302 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3303 execution are avoided.
3304 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3305
3306 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3307 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3308 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3309 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3310 default.
3311 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3312
3313 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3314 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3315 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3316 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3317 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3318 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3319 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3320 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3321 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3322 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3323
3324 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3325 @item --enable-auto-import
3326 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3327 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3328 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3329 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3330
3331 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3332 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3333
3334 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3335 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3336 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3337
3338 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3339 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3340 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3341 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3342 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3343
3344 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3345 see this message:
3346
3347 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3348 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3349
3350 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3351 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3352 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3353 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3354 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3355 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3356 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3357 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3358 the warning, and exit.
3359
3360 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3361 data type of the exported variable:
3362
3363 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3364 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3365 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3366
3367 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3368 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3369 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3370 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3371
3372 @example
3373 extern type extern_array[];
3374 extern_array[1] -->
3375 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3376 @end example
3377
3378 or
3379
3380 @example
3381 extern type extern_array[];
3382 extern_array[1] -->
3383 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3384 @end example
3385
3386 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3387 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3388
3389 @example
3390 extern struct s extern_struct;
3391 extern_struct.field -->
3392 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3393 @end example
3394
3395 or
3396
3397 @example
3398 extern long long extern_ll;
3399 extern_ll -->
3400 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3401 @end example
3402
3403 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3404 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3405 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3406 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3407 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3408 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3409 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3410 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3411
3412 Original:
3413 @example
3414 --foo.h
3415 extern int arr[];
3416 --foo.c
3417 #include "foo.h"
3418 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3420 @}
3421 @end example
3422
3423 Solution 1:
3424 @example
3425 --foo.h
3426 extern int arr[];
3427 --foo.c
3428 #include "foo.h"
3429 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3430 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3431 volatile int *parr = arr;
3432 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3433 @}
3434 @end example
3435
3436 Solution 2:
3437 @example
3438 --foo.h
3439 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3440 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3441 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3442 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3443 #else
3444 #define FOO_IMPORT
3445 #endif
3446 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3447 --foo.c
3448 #include "foo.h"
3449 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3450 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3451 @}
3452 @end example
3453
3454 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3455 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3456 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3457 functions).
3458
3459 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3460 @item --disable-auto-import
3461 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3462 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3463 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3464
3465 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3466 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3467 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3468 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3469 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3470 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3471 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3472
3473 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3474 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3475 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3476 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3477
3478 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3479 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3480 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3481 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3482
3483 @kindex --section-alignment
3484 @item --section-alignment
3485 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3486 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3487 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3488
3489 @cindex stack size
3490 @kindex --stack
3491 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3492 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3493 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3494 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3495 committed.
3496 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3497
3498 @kindex --subsystem
3499 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3500 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3501 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3502 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3503 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3504 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3505 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3506 @var{which}.
3507 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3508
3509 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3510 of the PE file header:
3511 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3512
3513 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3514 @item --high-entropy-va
3515 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3516 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3517 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3518
3519 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3520 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3521
3522 @kindex --dynamicbase
3523 @item --dynamicbase
3524 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3525 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3526 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3527 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3528 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3529 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3530
3531 @kindex --forceinteg
3532 @item --forceinteg
3533 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3534 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3535 default.
3536
3537 @kindex --nxcompat
3538 @item --nxcompat
3539 @item --disable-nxcompat
3540 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3541 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3542 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3543
3544 @kindex --no-isolation
3545 @item --no-isolation
3546 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3547 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3548 This option is disabled by default.
3549
3550 @kindex --no-seh
3551 @item --no-seh
3552 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3553 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3554 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3555
3556 @kindex --no-bind
3557 @item --no-bind
3558 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3559 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3560
3561 @kindex --wdmdriver
3562 @item --wdmdriver
3563 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3564 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3565 by default.
3566
3567 @kindex --tsaware
3568 @item --tsaware
3569 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3570 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3571 default.
3572
3573 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3574 @item --insert-timestamp
3575 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3576 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3577 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3578 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3579 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3580 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3581 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3582 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3583 identically.
3584
3585 If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3586 either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3587 @code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3588 of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3589
3590 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3591 @item --enable-reloc-section
3592 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3593 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3594 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3595 This option is enabled by default.
3596 @end table
3597
3598 @c man end
3599
3600 @ifset C6X
3601 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3602
3603 @c man begin OPTIONS
3604
3605 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3606 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3607 all executables use an index of 0.
3608
3609 @table @gcctabopt
3610
3611 @kindex --dsbt-size
3612 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3613 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3614 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3615 entries.
3616
3617 @kindex --dsbt-index
3618 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3619 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3620 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3621 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3622 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3623
3624 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3625 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3626 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3627
3628 @end table
3629
3630 @c man end
3631 @end ifset
3632
3633 @ifset CSKY
3634 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3635
3636 @c man begin OPTIONS
3637
3638 @table @gcctabopt
3639
3640 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3641 @item --branch-stub
3642 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3643 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3644 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3645 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3646 the compiler or assembler.
3647
3648 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3649 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3650 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3651 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3652 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3653 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3654 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3655 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3656 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3657
3658 @end table
3659
3660 @c man end
3661 @end ifset
3662
3663 @ifset M68HC11
3664 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3665
3666 @c man begin OPTIONS
3667
3668 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3669 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3670
3671 @table @gcctabopt
3672
3673 @kindex --no-trampoline
3674 @item --no-trampoline
3675 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3676 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3677 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3678
3679 @kindex --bank-window
3680 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3681 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3682 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3683 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3684 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3685
3686 @end table
3687
3688 @c man end
3689 @end ifset
3690
3691 @ifset M68K
3692 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3693
3694 @c man begin OPTIONS
3695
3696 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3697 when linking for 68K targets.
3698
3699 @table @gcctabopt
3700
3701 @kindex --got
3702 @item --got=@var{type}
3703 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3704 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3705 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3706 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3707
3708 @end table
3709
3710 @c man end
3711 @end ifset
3712
3713 @ifset MIPS
3714 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3715
3716 @c man begin OPTIONS
3717
3718 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3719 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3720 linking for MIPS targets.
3721
3722 @table @gcctabopt
3723
3724 @kindex --insn32
3725 @item --insn32
3726 @kindex --no-insn32
3727 @itemx --no-insn32
3728 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3729 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3730 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3731 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3732 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3733 possible.
3734
3735 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3736 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3737 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3738 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3739 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3740 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3741 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3742 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3743 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3744 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3745 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3746 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3747 an error.
3748
3749 @kindex --compact-branches
3750 @item --compact-branches
3751 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3752 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3753 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3754 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3755
3756 @end table
3757
3758 @c man end
3759 @end ifset
3760
3761
3762 @ifset PDP11
3763 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3764
3765 @c man begin OPTIONS
3766
3767 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3768 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3769 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3770 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3771 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3772 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3773
3774 @table @gcctabopt
3775
3776 @kindex -N
3777 @item -N
3778 @kindex --omagic
3779 @itemx --omagic
3780
3781 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3782 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3783 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3784 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3785 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3786 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3787 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3788
3789 @kindex -n
3790 @item -n
3791 @kindex --nmagic
3792 @itemx --nmagic
3793
3794 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3795 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3796 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3797 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3798 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3799 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3800
3801 @kindex -z
3802 @item -z
3803 @kindex --imagic
3804 @itemx --imagic
3805
3806 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3807 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3808 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3809 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3810 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3811 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3812 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3813 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3814 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3815 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3816 executable} format.
3817
3818 @kindex --no-omagic
3819 @item --no-omagic
3820
3821 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3822
3823 @end table
3824
3825 @c man end
3826 @end ifset
3827
3828 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3829 @node Environment
3830 @section Environment Variables
3831
3832 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3833
3834 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3835 @ifclear SingleFormat
3836 @code{GNUTARGET},
3837 @end ifclear
3838 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3839
3840 @ifclear SingleFormat
3841 @kindex GNUTARGET
3842 @cindex default input format
3843 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3844 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3845 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3846 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3847 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3848 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3849 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3850 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3851 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3852 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3853 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3854 @end ifclear
3855
3856 @kindex LDEMULATION
3857 @cindex default emulation
3858 @cindex emulation, default
3859 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3860 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3861 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3862 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3863 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3864 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3865 linker was configured.
3866
3867 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3868 @cindex demangling, default
3869 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3870 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3871 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3872 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3873 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3874 options.
3875
3876 @c man end
3877 @end ifset
3878
3879 @node Scripts
3880 @chapter Linker Scripts
3881
3882 @cindex scripts
3883 @cindex linker scripts
3884 @cindex command files
3885 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3886 written in the linker command language.
3887
3888 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3889 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3890 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3891 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3892 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3893 described below.
3894
3895 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3896 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3897 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3898 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3899 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3900
3901 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3902 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3903 default linker script.
3904
3905 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3906 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3907 Linker Scripts}.
3908
3909 @menu
3910 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3911 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3912 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3913 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3914 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3915 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3916 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3917 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3918 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3919 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3920 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3921 @end menu
3922
3923 @node Basic Script Concepts
3924 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3925 @cindex linker script concepts
3926 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3927 describe the linker script language.
3928
3929 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3930 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3931 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3932 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3933 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3934 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3935 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3936 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3937
3938 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3939 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3940 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3941 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3942 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3943 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3944 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3945 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3946 of debugging information.
3947
3948 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3949 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3950 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3951 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3952 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3953 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3954 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3955 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3956 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3957 RAM address would be the VMA.
3958
3959 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3960 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3961
3962 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3963 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3964 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3965 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3966 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3967 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3968 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3969
3970 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3971 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3972 option.
3973
3974 @node Script Format
3975 @section Linker Script Format
3976 @cindex linker script format
3977 Linker scripts are text files.
3978
3979 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3980 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3981 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3982 generally ignored.
3983
3984 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3985 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3986 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3987 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3988 file name.
3989
3990 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3991 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3992 to whitespace.
3993
3994 @node Simple Example
3995 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3996 @cindex linker script example
3997 @cindex example of linker script
3998 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3999
4000 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
4001 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
4002 memory layout of the output file.
4003
4004 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
4005 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
4006 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
4007 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
4008 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
4009 your input files.
4010
4011 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
4012 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4013 linker script which will do that:
4014 @smallexample
4015 SECTIONS
4016 @{
4017 . = 0x10000;
4018 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4019 . = 0x8000000;
4020 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4021 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4022 @}
4023 @end smallexample
4024
4025 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4026 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4027 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4028
4029 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4030 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4031 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4032 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4033 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4034 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4035 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4036
4037 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4038 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4039 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4040 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4041 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4042 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4043
4044 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4045 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4046 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4047
4048 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4049 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4050 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4051 output section, the value of the location counter will be
4052 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4053 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
4054 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
4055
4056 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4057 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4058 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4059 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4060 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4061 sections.
4062
4063 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4064
4065 @node Simple Commands
4066 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
4067 @cindex linker script simple commands
4068 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4069
4070 @menu
4071 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4072 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4073 @ifclear SingleFormat
4074 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4075 @end ifclear
4076
4077 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
4078 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4079 @end menu
4080
4081 @node Entry Point
4082 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
4083 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4084 @cindex start of execution
4085 @cindex first instruction
4086 @cindex entry point
4087 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4088 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4089 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4090 @smallexample
4091 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4092 @end smallexample
4093
4094 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4095 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4096 stopping when one of them succeeds:
4097 @itemize @bullet
4098 @item
4099 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
4100 @item
4101 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
4102 @item
4103 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
4104 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
4105 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
4106 @item
4107 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4108 executable is being created - the code section is usually
4109 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
4110 @item
4111 The address @code{0}.
4112 @end itemize
4113
4114 @node File Commands
4115 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
4116 @cindex linker script file commands
4117 Several linker script commands deal with files.
4118
4119 @table @code
4120 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4121 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4122 @cindex including a linker script
4123 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4124 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
4125 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
4126 10 levels deep.
4127
4128 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4129 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4130
4131 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4132 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4133 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4134 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4135 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4136 @cindex linker script input object files
4137 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4138 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4139
4140 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4141 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4142 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4143
4144 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4145 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4146
4147 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4148 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4149 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4150 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4151 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4152 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4153 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4154
4155 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4156 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4157 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4158 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4159 path.
4160
4161 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4162 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4163 @samp{-l}.
4164
4165 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4166 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4167 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4168
4169 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4170 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4171 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4172 @cindex grouping input files
4173 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4174 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4175 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4176 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4177
4178 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4179 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4180 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4181 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4182 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4183 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4184 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4185 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4186 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4187 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4188 setting afterwards.
4189
4190 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4191 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4192 @cindex output file name in linker script
4193 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4194 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4195 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4196 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4197 precedence.
4198
4199 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4200 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4201
4202 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4203 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4204 @cindex library search path in linker script
4205 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4206 @cindex search path in linker script
4207 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4208 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4209 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4210 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4211 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4212 the command-line option are searched first.
4213
4214 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4215 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4216 @cindex first input file
4217 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4218 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4219 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4220 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4221 first file.
4222 @end table
4223
4224 @ifclear SingleFormat
4225 @node Format Commands
4226 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4227 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4228
4229 @table @code
4230 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4231 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4232 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4233 @cindex output file format in linker script
4234 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4235 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4236 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4237 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4238 line option takes precedence.
4239
4240 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4241 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4242 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4243 desired endianness.
4244
4245 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4246 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4247 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4248 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4249
4250 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4251 command:
4252 @smallexample
4253 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4254 @end smallexample
4255 This says that the default format for the output file is
4256 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4257 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4258 format.
4259
4260 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4261 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4262 @cindex input file format in linker script
4263 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4264 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4265 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4266 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4267 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4268 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4269 @end table
4270 @end ifclear
4271
4272 @node REGION_ALIAS
4273 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4274 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4275 @cindex region alias
4276 @cindex region names
4277
4278 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4279 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4280
4281 @smallexample
4282 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4283 @end smallexample
4284
4285 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4286 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4287 to memory regions. An example follows.
4288
4289 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4290 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4291 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4292 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4293 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4294 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4295 sections:
4296
4297 @itemize @bullet
4298 @item
4299 @code{.text} program code;
4300 @item
4301 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4302 @item
4303 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4304 @item
4305 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4306 @end itemize
4307
4308 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4309 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4310 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4311 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4312 @code{C}:
4313 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4314 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4315 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4316 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4317 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4318 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4319 @end multitable
4320 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4321 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4322 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4323 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4324
4325 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4326 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4327 memory layout:
4328 @smallexample
4329 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4330
4331 SECTIONS
4332 @{
4333 .text :
4334 @{
4335 *(.text)
4336 @} > REGION_TEXT
4337 .rodata :
4338 @{
4339 *(.rodata)
4340 rodata_end = .;
4341 @} > REGION_RODATA
4342 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4343 @{
4344 data_start = .;
4345 *(.data)
4346 @} > REGION_DATA
4347 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4348 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4349 .bss :
4350 @{
4351 *(.bss)
4352 @} > REGION_BSS
4353 @}
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4357 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4358 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4359 @table @code
4360 @item A
4361 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4362 @smallexample
4363 MEMORY
4364 @{
4365 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4366 @}
4367
4368 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4369 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4370 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4371 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4372 @end smallexample
4373 @item B
4374 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4375 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4376 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4377 @smallexample
4378 MEMORY
4379 @{
4380 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4381 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4382 @}
4383
4384 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4385 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4386 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4387 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4388 @end smallexample
4389 @item C
4390 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4391 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4392 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4393 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4394 @smallexample
4395 MEMORY
4396 @{
4397 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4398 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4399 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4400 @}
4401
4402 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4403 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4404 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4405 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4406 @end smallexample
4407 @end table
4408
4409 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4410 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4411 necessary:
4412 @smallexample
4413 #include <string.h>
4414
4415 extern char data_start [];
4416 extern char data_size [];
4417 extern char data_load_start [];
4418
4419 void copy_data(void)
4420 @{
4421 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4422 @{
4423 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4424 @}
4425 @}
4426 @end smallexample
4427
4428 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4429 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4430 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4431
4432 @table @code
4433 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4434 @kindex ASSERT
4435 @cindex assertion in linker script
4436 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4437 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4438
4439 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4440 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4441 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4442 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4443 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 .stack :
4447 @{
4448 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4449 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4450 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4451 @}
4452 @end smallexample
4453
4454 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4455 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4456 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4457
4458 @smallexample
4459 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4460 .stack :
4461 @{
4462 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4463 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4464 @}
4465 @end smallexample
4466
4467 will work.
4468
4469 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4470 @kindex EXTERN
4471 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4472 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4473 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4474 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4475 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4476 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4477
4478 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4479 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4480 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4481 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4482 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4483 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4484
4485 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4486 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4487 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4488 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4489 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4490 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4491
4492 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4493 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4494 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4495 @cindex section groups
4496 @cindex COMDAT
4497 This command has the same effect as the
4498 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4499 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4500 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4501 specified (@samp{-r}).
4502
4503 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4504 @kindex INSERT
4505 @cindex insert user script into default script
4506 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4507 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4508 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4509 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4510 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4511 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4512 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4513 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4514 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4515 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4516 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4517 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4518 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4519
4520 @smallexample
4521 SECTIONS
4522 @{
4523 OVERLAY :
4524 @{
4525 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4526 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4527 @}
4528 @}
4529 INSERT AFTER .text;
4530 @end smallexample
4531
4532 Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4533 script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4534 of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4535 The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4536 command line.
4537
4538 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4539 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4540 @cindex cross references
4541 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4542 references among certain output sections.
4543
4544 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4545 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4546 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4547 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4548 a function defined in the other section.
4549
4550 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4551 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4552 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4553 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4554 names.
4555
4556 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4557 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4558 @cindex cross references
4559 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4560 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4561
4562 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4563 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4564 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4565 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4566 must never call back.
4567
4568 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4569 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4570 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4571 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4572 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4573 names, not input section names.
4574
4575 @ifclear SingleFormat
4576 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4577 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4578 @cindex machine architecture
4579 @cindex architecture
4580 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4581 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4582 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4583 the @samp{-f} option.
4584 @end ifclear
4585
4586 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4587 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4588 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4589 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4590 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4591 @xref{Expression Section}.
4592 @end table
4593
4594 @node Assignments
4595 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4596 @cindex assignment in scripts
4597 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4598 @cindex variables, defining
4599 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4600 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4601
4602 @menu
4603 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4604 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4605 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4606 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4607 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4608 @end menu
4609
4610 @node Simple Assignments
4611 @subsection Simple Assignments
4612
4613 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4614
4615 @table @code
4616 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4617 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4618 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4619 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4620 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4621 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4622 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4623 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4624 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4625 @end table
4626
4627 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4628 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4629 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4630
4631 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4632 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4633
4634 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4635
4636 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4637
4638 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4639 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4640 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4641
4642 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4643 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4644
4645 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4646 assignments may be used:
4647
4648 @smallexample
4649 floating_point = 0;
4650 SECTIONS
4651 @{
4652 .text :
4653 @{
4654 *(.text)
4655 _etext = .;
4656 @}
4657 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4658 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4659 @}
4660 @end smallexample
4661 @noindent
4662 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4663 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4664 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4665 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4666 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4667
4668 @node HIDDEN
4669 @subsection HIDDEN
4670 @cindex HIDDEN
4671 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4672 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4673
4674 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4675 @code{HIDDEN}:
4676
4677 @smallexample
4678 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4679 SECTIONS
4680 @{
4681 .text :
4682 @{
4683 *(.text)
4684 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4685 @}
4686 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4687 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4688 @}
4689 @end smallexample
4690 @noindent
4691 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4692
4693 @node PROVIDE
4694 @subsection PROVIDE
4695 @cindex PROVIDE
4696 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4697 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4698 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4699 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4700 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4701 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4702 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4703 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4704
4705 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4706 @smallexample
4707 SECTIONS
4708 @{
4709 .text :
4710 @{
4711 *(.text)
4712 _etext = .;
4713 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4714 @}
4715 @}
4716 @end smallexample
4717
4718 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4719 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4720 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4721 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4722 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4723 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4724
4725 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4726 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4727 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4728 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4729 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4730
4731 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4732 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4733 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4734 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4735 hidden and won't be exported.
4736
4737 @node Source Code Reference
4738 @subsection Source Code Reference
4739
4740 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4741 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4742 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4743 symbol that does not have a value.
4744
4745 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4746 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4747 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4748 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4749 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4750 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4751 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4752 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4753
4754 @smallexample
4755 extern int foo;
4756 @end smallexample
4757
4758 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4759
4760 @smallexample
4761 _foo = 1000;
4762 @end smallexample
4763
4764 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4765 transformation has taken place.
4766
4767 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4768 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4769 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4770 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4771 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4772 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4773 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 int foo = 1000;
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4780 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4781 number 1000 is initially stored.
4782
4783 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4784 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4785 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4786 So:
4787
4788 @smallexample
4789 foo = 1;
4790 @end smallexample
4791
4792 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4793 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4794 address. Whereas:
4795
4796 @smallexample
4797 int * a = & foo;
4798 @end smallexample
4799
4800 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4801 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4802 the variable @samp{a}.
4803
4804 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4805 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4806 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 foo = 1000;
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4813 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4814 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4815 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4816 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4817
4818 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4819 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4820 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4821 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4822 linker script contains these declarations:
4823
4824 @smallexample
4825 @group
4826 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4827 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4828 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4829 @end group
4830 @end smallexample
4831
4832 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4833
4834 @smallexample
4835 @group
4836 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4837
4838 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4839 @end group
4840 @end smallexample
4841
4842 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4843 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4844 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4845
4846 @smallexample
4847 @group
4848 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4849
4850 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4851 @end group
4852 @end smallexample
4853
4854 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4855 operators.
4856
4857 @node SECTIONS
4858 @section SECTIONS Command
4859 @kindex SECTIONS
4860 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4861 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4862
4863 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4864 @smallexample
4865 SECTIONS
4866 @{
4867 @var{sections-command}
4868 @var{sections-command}
4869 @dots{}
4870 @}
4871 @end smallexample
4872
4873 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4874
4875 @itemize @bullet
4876 @item
4877 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4878 @item
4879 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4880 @item
4881 an output section description
4882 @item
4883 an overlay description
4884 @end itemize
4885
4886 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4887 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4888 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4889 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4890 the layout of the output file.
4891
4892 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4893 below.
4894
4895 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4896 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4897 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4898 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4899 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4900 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4901
4902 @menu
4903 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4904 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4905 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4906 * Input Section:: Input section description
4907 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4908 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4909 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4910 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4911 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4912 @end menu
4913
4914 @node Output Section Description
4915 @subsection Output Section Description
4916 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4917 @smallexample
4918 @group
4919 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4920 [AT(@var{lma})]
4921 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4922 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4923 [@var{constraint}]
4924 @{
4925 @var{output-section-command}
4926 @var{output-section-command}
4927 @dots{}
4928 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4929 @end group
4930 @end smallexample
4931
4932 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4933
4934 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4935 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4936 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4937 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4938 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4939
4940 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4941
4942 @itemize @bullet
4943 @item
4944 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4945 @item
4946 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4947 @item
4948 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4949 @item
4950 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4951 @end itemize
4952
4953 @node Output Section Name
4954 @subsection Output Section Name
4955 @cindex name, section
4956 @cindex section name
4957 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4958 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4959 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4960 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4961 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4962 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4963 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4964 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4965 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4966 commas must be quoted.
4967
4968 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4969 Discarding}.
4970
4971 @node Output Section Address
4972 @subsection Output Section Address
4973 @cindex address, section
4974 @cindex section address
4975 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4976 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4977 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4978
4979 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4980 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4981 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4982 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4983 contained within the output section.
4984
4985 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4986
4987 @itemize @bullet
4988 @item
4989 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4990 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4991 in that region.
4992
4993 @item
4994 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4995 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4996 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4997 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4998
4999 @item
5000 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
5001 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
5002 counter.
5003 @end itemize
5004
5005 @noindent
5006 For example:
5007
5008 @smallexample
5009 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
5010 @end smallexample
5011
5012 @noindent
5013 and
5014
5015 @smallexample
5016 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5017 @end smallexample
5018
5019 @noindent
5020 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5021 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5022 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
5023 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5024 input sections.
5025
5026 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5027 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5028 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5029 do something like this:
5030 @smallexample
5031 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5032 @end smallexample
5033 @noindent
5034 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5035 aligned upward to the specified value.
5036
5037 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
5038 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5039 sections are ignored).
5040
5041 @node Input Section
5042 @subsection Input Section Description
5043 @cindex input sections
5044 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5045 The most common output section command is an input section description.
5046
5047 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5048 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5049 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5050 map the input files into your memory layout.
5051
5052 @menu
5053 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5054 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5055 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5056 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5057 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
5058 @end menu
5059
5060 @node Input Section Basics
5061 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
5062 @cindex input section basics
5063 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5064 by a list of section names in parentheses.
5065
5066 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5067 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5068
5069 The most common input section description is to include all input
5070 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5071 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5072 @smallexample
5073 *(.text)
5074 @end smallexample
5075 @noindent
5076 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
5077 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
5078 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5079 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5080 example:
5081 @smallexample
5082 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5083 @end smallexample
5084 @noindent
5085 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5086 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5087 placed inside the section list, for example:
5088 @smallexample
5089 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
5090 @end smallexample
5091 @noindent
5092 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5093 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5094 more than one section, as described below.
5095
5096 There are two ways to include more than one section:
5097 @smallexample
5098 *(.text .rdata)
5099 *(.text) *(.rdata)
5100 @end smallexample
5101 @noindent
5102 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5103 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
5104 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5105 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
5106 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5107 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
5108
5109 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5110 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5111 immediately following section, for example:
5112 @smallexample
5113 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5114 @end smallexample
5115 @noindent
5116 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5117 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5118 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5119 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
5120 could be modified to:
5121 @smallexample
5122 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5123 @end smallexample
5124 @noindent
5125 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5126 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5127 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5128 @smallexample
5129 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5130 @end smallexample
5131
5132 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5133 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5134 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5135 @smallexample
5136 data.o(.data)
5137 @end smallexample
5138
5139 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5140 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5141
5142 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5143
5144 @smallexample
5145 @group
5146 SECTIONS @{
5147 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5148 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5149 @}
5150 @end group
5151 @end smallexample
5152
5153 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5154 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5155 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5156 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5157 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5158
5159 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5160 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5161 with no whitespace around the colon.
5162
5163 @table @samp
5164 @item archive:file
5165 matches file within archive
5166 @item archive:
5167 matches the whole archive
5168 @item :file
5169 matches file but not one in an archive
5170 @end table
5171
5172 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5173 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5174 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5175 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5176 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5177 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5178 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5179 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5180 command.
5181
5182 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5183 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5184 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5185 @smallexample
5186 data.o
5187 @end smallexample
5188
5189 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5190 and does not contain any wild card
5191 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5192 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5193 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5194 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5195 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5196 the archive search path.
5197
5198 @node Input Section Wildcards
5199 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5200 @cindex input section wildcards
5201 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5202 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5203 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5204 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5205 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5206
5207 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5208 pattern for the file name.
5209
5210 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5211
5212 @table @samp
5213 @item *
5214 matches any number of characters
5215 @item ?
5216 matches any single character
5217 @item [@var{chars}]
5218 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5219 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5220 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5221 @item \
5222 quotes the following character
5223 @end table
5224
5225 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5226 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5227 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5228
5229 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5230 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5231 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5232 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5233 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5234 @smallexample
5235 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5236 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5237 @end smallexample
5238
5239 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5240 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5241 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5242 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5243 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5244 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5245 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5246
5247 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5248 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5249 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5250 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5251 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5252 needed.
5253
5254 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5255 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5256 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5257 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5258 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5259 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5260 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5261 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5262
5263 @cindex SORT
5264 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5265
5266 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5267 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5268
5269 @enumerate
5270 @item
5271 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5272 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5273 sections have the same name.
5274 @item
5275 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5276 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5277 sections have the same alignment.
5278 @item
5279 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5280 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5281 @item
5282 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5283 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5284 @item
5285 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5286 @end enumerate
5287
5288 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5289 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5290 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5291
5292 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5293 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5294 treated as nested sorting command.
5295
5296 @enumerate
5297 @item
5298 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5299 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5300 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5301 @item
5302 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5303 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5304 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5305 @end enumerate
5306
5307 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5308 command-line option will be ignored.
5309
5310 @cindex SORT_NONE
5311 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5312 section sorting option.
5313
5314 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5315 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5316 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5317
5318 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5319 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5320 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5321 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5322 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5323 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5324 @smallexample
5325 @group
5326 SECTIONS @{
5327 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5328 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5329 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5330 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5331 @}
5332 @end group
5333 @end smallexample
5334
5335 @node Input Section Common
5336 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5337 @cindex common symbol placement
5338 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5339 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5340 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5341 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5342 named @samp{COMMON}.
5343
5344 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5345 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5346 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5347 input files are placed in another section.
5348
5349 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5350 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5351 @smallexample
5352 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5353 @end smallexample
5354
5355 @cindex scommon section
5356 @cindex small common symbols
5357 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5358 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5359 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5360 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5361 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5362 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5363 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5364 locations.
5365
5366 @cindex [COMMON]
5367 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5368 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5369 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5370
5371 @node Input Section Keep
5372 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5373 @cindex KEEP
5374 @cindex garbage collection
5375 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5376 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5377 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5378 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5379 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5380
5381 @node Input Section Example
5382 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5383 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5384 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5385 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5386 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5387 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5388 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5389 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5390 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5391 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5392
5393 @smallexample
5394 @group
5395 SECTIONS @{
5396 outputa 0x10000 :
5397 @{
5398 all.o
5399 foo.o (.input1)
5400 @}
5401 @end group
5402 @group
5403 outputb :
5404 @{
5405 foo.o (.input2)
5406 foo1.o (.input1)
5407 @}
5408 @end group
5409 @group
5410 outputc :
5411 @{
5412 *(.input1)
5413 *(.input2)
5414 @}
5415 @}
5416 @end group
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5420 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5421 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5422 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5423 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5424 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5425 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5426
5427 @node Output Section Data
5428 @subsection Output Section Data
5429 @cindex data
5430 @cindex section data
5431 @cindex output section data
5432 @kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
5433 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5434 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5435 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5436 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5437 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5438 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5439 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5440 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5441 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5442 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5443 counter.
5444
5445 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5446 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5447 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5448 stored.
5449
5450 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5451 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5452 @smallexample
5453 BYTE(1)
5454 LONG(addr)
5455 @end smallexample
5456
5457 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5458 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5459 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5460 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5461 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5462
5463 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5464 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5465 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5466 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5467 endianness of the first input object file.
5468
5469 You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5470 @code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5471 the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5472 end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5473 quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5474 Hex numbers are not supported.
5475
5476 For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5477 @smallexample
5478 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5479 @end smallexample
5480
5481 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5482 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5483 @smallexample
5484 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5485 @end smallexample
5486 whereas this will work:
5487 @smallexample
5488 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5489 @end smallexample
5490
5491 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5492 @cindex holes, filling
5493 @cindex unspecified memory
5494 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5495 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5496 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5497 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5498 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5499 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5500 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5501 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5502 different parts of an output section.
5503
5504 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5505 value @samp{0x90}:
5506 @smallexample
5507 FILL(0x90909090)
5508 @end smallexample
5509
5510 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5511 section attribute, but it only affects the
5512 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5513 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5514 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5515 expression.
5516
5517 @kindex LINKER_VERSION
5518 @cindex LINKER_VERSION
5519 The @code{LINKER_VERSION} command inserts a string containing the
5520 version of the linker at the current point. Note - by default this
5521 directive is disabled and will do nothing. It only becomes active if
5522 the @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5523
5524 Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5525 directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5526
5527 @node Output Section Keywords
5528 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5529 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5530 commands.
5531
5532 @table @code
5533 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5534 @cindex input filename symbols
5535 @cindex filename symbols
5536 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5537 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5538 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5539 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5540 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5541
5542 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5543 normally used for any other object file format.
5544
5545 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5546 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5547 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5548 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5549 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5550 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5551 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5552 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5553 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5554 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5555 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5556 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5557 ignored for other object file formats.
5558
5559 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5560 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5561 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5562 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5563 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5564 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5565 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5566 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5567 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5568 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5569 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5570 @code{exit}.
5571
5572 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5573 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5574 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5575 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5576 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5577 runtime code expects to see.
5578
5579 @smallexample
5580 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5581 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5582 *(.ctors)
5583 LONG(0)
5584 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5585 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5586 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5587 *(.dtors)
5588 LONG(0)
5589 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5590 @end smallexample
5591
5592 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5593 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5594 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5595 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5596 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5597 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5598 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5599 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5600
5601 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5602 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5603 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5604 scripts.
5605
5606 @end table
5607
5608 @node Output Section Discarding
5609 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5610 @cindex discarding sections
5611 @cindex sections, discarding
5612 @cindex removing sections
5613 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5614 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5615 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5616 @smallexample
5617 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5618 @end smallexample
5619 @noindent
5620 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5621 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5622 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5623 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5624 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5625 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5626 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5627 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5628 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5629
5630 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5631 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5632 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5633 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5634 section is discarded.
5635
5636 @cindex /DISCARD/
5637 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5638 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5639 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5640
5641 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5642 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5643 garbage collection.
5644
5645 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5646 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5647 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5648 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5649
5650 @node Output Section Attributes
5651 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5652 @cindex output section attributes
5653 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5654 like this:
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 @group
5658 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5659 [AT(@var{lma})]
5660 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5661 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5662 [@var{constraint}]
5663 @{
5664 @var{output-section-command}
5665 @var{output-section-command}
5666 @dots{}
5667 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5668 @end group
5669 @end smallexample
5670
5671 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5672 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5673 remaining section attributes.
5674
5675 @menu
5676 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5677 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5678 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5679 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5680 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5681 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5682 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5683 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5684 @end menu
5685
5686 @node Output Section Type
5687 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5688 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5689 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5690
5691 @table @code
5692
5693 @item NOLOAD
5694 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5695 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5696
5697 @item READONLY
5698 The section should be marked as read-only.
5699
5700 @item DSECT
5701 @item COPY
5702 @item INFO
5703 @item OVERLAY
5704 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5705 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5706 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5707 section when the program is run.
5708
5709 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5710 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5711 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5712 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5713 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5714 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5715 special requirements of the section type are met.
5716
5717 Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5718 section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5719 @smallexample
5720 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5721 @end smallexample
5722 will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5723 @samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5724 type. Whereas:
5725 @smallexample
5726 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5727 @end smallexample
5728 will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5729 to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5730 type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5731 @smallexample
5732 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5733 @end smallexample
5734
5735 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5736 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5737 type specified by @var{type}.
5738
5739 @end table
5740
5741 @kindex NOLOAD
5742 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5743 @cindex loading, preventing
5744 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5745 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5746 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5747 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5748 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5749 @smallexample
5750 @group
5751 SECTIONS @{
5752 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5753 @dots{}
5754 @}
5755 @end group
5756 @end smallexample
5757
5758 @node Output Section LMA
5759 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5760 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5761 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5762 @cindex load address
5763 @cindex section load address
5764 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5765 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5766 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5767 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5768 address is optional.
5769
5770 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5771 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5772 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5773 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5774 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5775
5776 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5777 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5778 load address:
5779
5780 @itemize @bullet
5781 @item
5782 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5783 the LMA address as well.
5784
5785 @item
5786 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5787
5788 @item
5789 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5790 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5791 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5792 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5793 the last section in the located region.
5794
5795 @item
5796 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5797 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5798
5799 @item
5800 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5801 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5802 @end itemize
5803
5804 @cindex ROM initialized data
5805 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5806 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5807 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5808 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5809 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5810 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5811 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5812 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5813 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5814
5815 @smallexample
5816 @group
5817 SECTIONS
5818 @{
5819 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5820 .mdata 0x2000 :
5821 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5822 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5823 .bss 0x3000 :
5824 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5825 @}
5826 @end group
5827 @end smallexample
5828
5829 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5830 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5831 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5832 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5833 script.
5834
5835 @smallexample
5836 @group
5837 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5838 char *src = &_etext;
5839 char *dst = &_data;
5840
5841 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5842 while (dst < &_edata)
5843 *dst++ = *src++;
5844
5845 /* Zero bss. */
5846 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5847 *dst = 0;
5848 @end group
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 @node Forced Output Alignment
5852 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5853 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5854 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5855 @cindex output section alignment
5856 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5857 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5858 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5859
5860 @node Forced Input Alignment
5861 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5862 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5863 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5864 @cindex input section alignment
5865 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5866 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5867 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5868
5869 @node Output Section Constraint
5870 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5871 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5872 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5873 @cindex constraints on output sections
5874 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5875 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5876 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5877 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5878
5879 @node Output Section Region
5880 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5881 @kindex >@var{region}
5882 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5883 @cindex memory regions and sections
5884 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5885 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5886
5887 Here is a simple example:
5888 @smallexample
5889 @group
5890 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5891 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5892 @end group
5893 @end smallexample
5894
5895 @node Output Section Phdr
5896 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5897 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5898 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5899 @cindex program headers and sections
5900 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5901 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5902 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5903 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5904 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5905 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5906
5907 Here is a simple example:
5908 @smallexample
5909 @group
5910 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5911 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5912 @end group
5913 @end smallexample
5914
5915 @node Output Section Fill
5916 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5917 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5918 @cindex section fill pattern
5919 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5920 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5921 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5922 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5923 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5924 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5925 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5926 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5927 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5928 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5929 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5930 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5931 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5932
5933 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5934 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5935
5936 Here is a simple example:
5937 @smallexample
5938 @group
5939 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5940 @end group
5941 @end smallexample
5942
5943 @node Overlay Description
5944 @subsection Overlay Description
5945 @kindex OVERLAY
5946 @cindex overlays
5947 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5948 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5949 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5950 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5951 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5952 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5953 than another.
5954
5955 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5956 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5957 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5958 command is as follows:
5959 @smallexample
5960 @group
5961 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5962 @{
5963 @var{secname1}
5964 @{
5965 @var{output-section-command}
5966 @var{output-section-command}
5967 @dots{}
5968 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5969 @var{secname2}
5970 @{
5971 @var{output-section-command}
5972 @var{output-section-command}
5973 @dots{}
5974 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5975 @dots{}
5976 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5977 @end group
5978 @end smallexample
5979
5980 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5981 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5982 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5983 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5984 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5985 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5986
5987 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5988 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5989
5990 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5991 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5992 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5993 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5994 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5995 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5996
5997 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5998 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5999 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
6000 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
6001 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
6002
6003 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
6004 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
6005 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
6006 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
6007 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
6008 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
6009 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
6010
6011 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6012 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6013
6014 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6015 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
6016 @smallexample
6017 @group
6018 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6019 @{
6020 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6021 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6022 @}
6023 @end group
6024 @end smallexample
6025 @noindent
6026 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6027 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6028 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
6029 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
6030 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6031 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
6032
6033 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6034 like the following.
6035
6036 @smallexample
6037 @group
6038 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6039 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6040 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6041 @end group
6042 @end smallexample
6043
6044 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6045 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6046 example could have been written identically as follows.
6047
6048 @smallexample
6049 @group
6050 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6051 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6052 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
6053 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6054 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6055 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
6056 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6057 @end group
6058 @end smallexample
6059
6060 @node MEMORY
6061 @section MEMORY Command
6062 @kindex MEMORY
6063 @cindex memory regions
6064 @cindex regions of memory
6065 @cindex allocating memory
6066 @cindex discontinuous memory
6067 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6068 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6069
6070 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6071 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6072 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6073 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6074 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6075 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6076 around to fit into the available regions.
6077
6078 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6079 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6080 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6081 @code{MEMORY} is:
6082 @smallexample
6083 @group
6084 MEMORY
6085 @{
6086 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6087 @dots{}
6088 @}
6089 @end group
6090 @end smallexample
6091
6092 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6093 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6094 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6095 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
6096 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6097 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
6098 command.
6099
6100 @cindex memory region attributes
6101 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6102 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6103 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6104 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6105 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6106 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6107 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6108
6109 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6110 @table @samp
6111 @item R
6112 Read-only section
6113 @item W
6114 Read/write section
6115 @item X
6116 Executable section
6117 @item A
6118 Allocatable section
6119 @item I
6120 Initialized section
6121 @item L
6122 Same as @samp{I}
6123 @item !
6124 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
6125 @end table
6126
6127 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
6128 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
6129 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6130 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6131 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6132 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6133 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6134 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
6135
6136 @kindex ORIGIN =
6137 @kindex o =
6138 @kindex org =
6139 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6140 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6141 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6142 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6143 @code{ORG}).
6144
6145 @kindex LENGTH =
6146 @kindex len =
6147 @kindex l =
6148 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6149 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
6150 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6151 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
6152
6153 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6154 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6155 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6156 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6157 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6158 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6159 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6160 region.
6161
6162 @smallexample
6163 @group
6164 MEMORY
6165 @{
6166 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6167 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6168 @}
6169 @end group
6170 @end smallexample
6171
6172 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6173 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6174 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6175 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6176 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6177 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6178 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6179 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6180 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6181
6182 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6183 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6184 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6185
6186 @smallexample
6187 @group
6188 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6189 @end group
6190 @end smallexample
6191
6192 @node PHDRS
6193 @section PHDRS Command
6194 @kindex PHDRS
6195 @cindex program headers
6196 @cindex ELF program headers
6197 @cindex program segments
6198 @cindex segments, ELF
6199 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6200 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6201 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6202 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6203
6204 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6205 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6206 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6207 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6208 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6209
6210 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6211 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6212 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6213 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6214 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6215
6216 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6217 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6218 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6219
6220 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6221 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6222
6223 @smallexample
6224 @group
6225 PHDRS
6226 @{
6227 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6228 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6229 @}
6230 @end group
6231 @end smallexample
6232
6233 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6234 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6235 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6236 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6237 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6238 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6239
6240 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6241 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6242 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6243 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6244 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6245 Section Phdr}.
6246
6247 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6248 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6249 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6250 contain the section.
6251
6252 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6253 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6254 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6255 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6256 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6257 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6258 segment at all.
6259
6260 @kindex FILEHDR
6261 @kindex PHDRS
6262 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6263 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6264 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6265 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6266 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6267 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6268 these keywords.
6269
6270 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6271 value of the keyword.
6272
6273 @table @asis
6274 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6275 Indicates an unused program header.
6276
6277 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6278 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6279 the file.
6280
6281 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6282 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6283
6284 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6285 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6286 found.
6287
6288 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6289 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6290
6291 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6292 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6293 ABI.
6294
6295 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6296 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6297
6298 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6299 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6300
6301 @item @var{expression}
6302 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6303 be used for types not defined above.
6304 @end table
6305
6306 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6307 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6308 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6309 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6310 output section attribute.
6311
6312 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6313 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6314 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6315 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6316 header.
6317
6318 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6319 headers used on a native ELF system.
6320
6321 @example
6322 @group
6323 PHDRS
6324 @{
6325 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6326 interp PT_INTERP ;
6327 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6328 data PT_LOAD ;
6329 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6330 @}
6331
6332 SECTIONS
6333 @{
6334 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6335 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6336 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6337 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6338 @dots{}
6339 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6340 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6341 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6342 @dots{}
6343 @}
6344 @end group
6345 @end example
6346
6347 @node VERSION
6348 @section VERSION Command
6349 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6350 @cindex symbol versions
6351 @cindex version script
6352 @cindex versions of symbols
6353 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6354 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6355 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6356 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6357 shared library.
6358
6359 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6360 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6361 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6362
6363 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6364 @smallexample
6365 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6366 @end smallexample
6367
6368 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6369 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6370 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6371 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6372 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6373 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6374 library.
6375
6376 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6377 examples.
6378
6379 @smallexample
6380 VERS_1.1 @{
6381 global:
6382 foo1;
6383 local:
6384 old*;
6385 original*;
6386 new*;
6387 @};
6388
6389 VERS_1.2 @{
6390 foo2;
6391 @} VERS_1.1;
6392
6393 VERS_2.0 @{
6394 bar1; bar2;
6395 extern "C++" @{
6396 ns::*;
6397 "f(int, double)";
6398 @};
6399 @} VERS_1.2;
6400 @end smallexample
6401
6402 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6403 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6404 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6405 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6406 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6407 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6408 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6409 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6410 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6411 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6412
6413 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6414 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6415 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6416
6417 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6418 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6419 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6420
6421 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6422 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6423 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6424 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6425 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6426 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6427 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6428 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6429 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6430
6431 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6432 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6433 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6434 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6435
6436 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6437 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6438 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6439 won't.
6440
6441 @smallexample
6442 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6443 @end smallexample
6444
6445 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6446 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6447 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6448 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6449 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6450 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6451 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6452 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6453 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6454 search for each symbol reference.
6455
6456 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6457 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6458 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6459 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6460 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6461 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6462 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6463 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6464 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6465
6466 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6467 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6468 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6469 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6470 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6471 @smallexample
6472 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6473 @end smallexample
6474 @noindent
6475 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6476 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6477 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6478 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6479 takes precedence over a version script.
6480
6481 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6482 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6483 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6484 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6485 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6486
6487 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6488 source file. Here is an example:
6489
6490 @smallexample
6491 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6492 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6493 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6494 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6495 @end smallexample
6496
6497 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6498 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6499 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6500 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6501
6502 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6503 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6504 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6505 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6506 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6507 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6508
6509 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6510 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6511 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6512 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6513
6514 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6515
6516 @smallexample
6517 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6518 @end smallexample
6519
6520 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6521 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6522 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6523 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6524 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6525
6526 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6527 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6528 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6529 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6530 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6531 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6532 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6533 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6534 expect when you upgrade.
6535
6536 @node Expressions
6537 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6538 @cindex expressions
6539 @cindex arithmetic
6540 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6541 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6542 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6543 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6544 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6545 otherwise 64 bits.
6546
6547 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6548
6549 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6550 expressions.
6551
6552 @menu
6553 * Constants:: Constants
6554 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6555 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6556 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6557 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6558 * Operators:: Operators
6559 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6560 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6561 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6562 @end menu
6563
6564 @node Constants
6565 @subsection Constants
6566 @cindex integer notation
6567 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6568 All constants are integers.
6569
6570 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6571 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6572 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6573 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6574 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6575 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6576
6577 @cindex scaled integers
6578 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6579 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6580 @cindex suffixes for integers
6581 @cindex integer suffixes
6582 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6583 constant by
6584 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6585 @ifnottex
6586 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6587 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6588 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6589 @end ifnottex
6590 @tex
6591 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6592 @end tex
6593 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6594 respectively. For example, the following
6595 all refer to the same quantity:
6596
6597 @smallexample
6598 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6599 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6600 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6601 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6602 @end smallexample
6603
6604 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6605 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6606
6607 @node Symbolic Constants
6608 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6609 @cindex symbolic constants
6610 @kindex CONSTANT
6611 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6612 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6613
6614 @table @code
6615 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6616 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6617 The target's maximum page size.
6618
6619 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6620 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6621 The target's default page size.
6622 @end table
6623
6624 So for example:
6625
6626 @smallexample
6627 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6628 @end smallexample
6629
6630 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6631 supported by the target.
6632
6633 @node Symbols
6634 @subsection Symbol Names
6635 @cindex symbol names
6636 @cindex names
6637 @cindex quoted symbol names
6638 @kindex "
6639 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6640 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6641 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6642 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6643 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6644 @smallexample
6645 "SECTION" = 9;
6646 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6647 @end smallexample
6648
6649 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6650 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6651 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6652
6653 @node Orphan Sections
6654 @subsection Orphan Sections
6655 @cindex orphan
6656 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6657 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6658 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6659 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6660 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6661
6662 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6663 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6664 placed at the end of that output section.
6665
6666 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6667 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6668 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6669 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6670 one new output section.
6671
6672 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6673 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6674 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6675 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6676 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6677 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6678 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6679
6680 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6681 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6682 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6683
6684 @node Location Counter
6685 @subsection The Location Counter
6686 @kindex .
6687 @cindex dot
6688 @cindex location counter
6689 @cindex current output location
6690 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6691 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6692 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6693 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6694 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6695
6696 @cindex holes
6697 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6698 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6699 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6700 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6701 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6702
6703 @smallexample
6704 SECTIONS
6705 @{
6706 output :
6707 @{
6708 file1(.text)
6709 . = . + 1000;
6710 file2(.text)
6711 . += 1000;
6712 file3(.text)
6713 @} = 0x12345678;
6714 @}
6715 @end smallexample
6716 @noindent
6717 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6718 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6719 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6720 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6721 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6722 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6723
6724 @cindex dot inside sections
6725 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6726 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6727 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6728 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6729 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6730 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6731
6732 @smallexample
6733 SECTIONS
6734 @{
6735 . = 0x100
6736 .text: @{
6737 *(.text)
6738 . = 0x200
6739 @}
6740 . = 0x500
6741 .data: @{
6742 *(.data)
6743 . += 0x600
6744 @}
6745 @}
6746 @end smallexample
6747
6748 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6749 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6750 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6751 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6752 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6753 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6754 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6755 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6756
6757 @cindex dot outside sections
6758 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6759 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6760 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6761
6762 @smallexample
6763 SECTIONS
6764 @{
6765 start_of_text = . ;
6766 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6767 end_of_text = . ;
6768
6769 start_of_data = . ;
6770 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6771 end_of_data = . ;
6772 @}
6773 @end smallexample
6774
6775 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6776 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6777 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6778 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6779 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6780 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6781 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6782 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6783 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6784 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6785 as follows:
6786
6787 @smallexample
6788 SECTIONS
6789 @{
6790 start_of_text = . ;
6791 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6792 end_of_text = . ;
6793
6794 start_of_data = . ;
6795 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6796 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6797 end_of_data = . ;
6798 @}
6799 @end smallexample
6800
6801 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6802 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6803 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6804 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6805 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6806 section. So you could write:
6807
6808 @smallexample
6809 SECTIONS
6810 @{
6811 start_of_text = . ;
6812 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6813 end_of_text = . ;
6814
6815 . = . ;
6816 start_of_data = . ;
6817 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6818 end_of_data = . ;
6819 @}
6820 @end smallexample
6821
6822 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6823 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6824
6825 @need 2000
6826 @node Operators
6827 @subsection Operators
6828 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6829 @cindex arithmetic operators
6830 @cindex precedence in expressions
6831 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6832 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6833 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6834 @ifnottex
6835 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6836 @smallexample
6837 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6838 (highest)
6839 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6840 2 left * / %
6841 3 left + -
6842 4 left >> <<
6843 5 left > < <= >=
6844 6 left == !=
6845 7 left &
6846 8 left ^
6847 9 left |
6848 10 left &&
6849 11 left ||
6850 12 right ? :
6851 13 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
6852 (lowest)
6853 @end smallexample
6854 Notes:
6855 (1) Prefix operators
6856 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6857 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6858 @end ifnottex
6859 @tex
6860 \vskip \baselineskip
6861 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6862 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6863 \hrule
6864 \halign
6865 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6866 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6867 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6868 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6869 \noalign{\hrule}
6870 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6871 &highest&&&&&\cr
6872 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6873 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6874 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6875 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6876 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6877 &5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6878 &6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6879 &7&&left&&\&&\cr
6880 &8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
6881 &9&&left&&|&\cr
6882 &10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6883 &11&&left&&||&\cr
6884 &12&&right&&? :&\cr
6885 &13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6886 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6887 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6888 \hrule}
6889 @end tex
6890 @iftex
6891 {
6892 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6893 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6894 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6895 }
6896 @end iftex
6897 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6898
6899 @node Evaluation
6900 @subsection Evaluation
6901 @cindex lazy evaluation
6902 @cindex expression evaluation order
6903 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6904 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6905
6906 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6907 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6908 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6909 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6910
6911 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6912 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6913 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6914 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6915
6916 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6917 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6918 allocation.
6919
6920 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6921 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6922
6923 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6924 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6925 following
6926 @smallexample
6927 @group
6928 SECTIONS
6929 @{
6930 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6931 @{ *(.text) @}
6932 @}
6933 @end group
6934 @end smallexample
6935 @noindent
6936 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6937 address}.
6938
6939 @node Expression Section
6940 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6941 @cindex expression sections
6942 @cindex absolute expressions
6943 @cindex relative expressions
6944 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6945 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6946 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6947 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6948 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6949 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6950 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6951 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6952 operations.
6953
6954 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6955 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6956 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6957 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6958 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6959 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6960 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6961 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6962 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6963 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6964 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6965 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6966 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6967 everywhere.
6968
6969 In the following simple example,
6970
6971 @smallexample
6972 @group
6973 SECTIONS
6974 @{
6975 . = 0x100;
6976 __executable_start = 0x100;
6977 .data :
6978 @{
6979 . = 0x10;
6980 __data_start = 0x10;
6981 *(.data)
6982 @}
6983 @dots{}
6984 @}
6985 @end group
6986 @end smallexample
6987
6988 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6989 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6990 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6991 section in the second two assignments.
6992
6993 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6994 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6995
6996 @itemize @bullet
6997 @item
6998 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6999 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
7000 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
7001 @item
7002 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
7003 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
7004 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
7005 @item
7006 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
7007 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
7008 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
7009 before applying the operator.
7010 @end itemize
7011
7012 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7013
7014 @itemize @bullet
7015 @item
7016 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7017 @item
7018 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7019 @item
7020 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
7021 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
7022 (after above conversions) is also a number when
7023 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7024 but an absolute address otherwise.
7025 @item
7026 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7027 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7028 section as the relative operand(s).
7029 @item
7030 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7031 conversions) is an absolute address.
7032 @end itemize
7033
7034 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7035 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7036 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7037 section @samp{.data}:
7038 @smallexample
7039 SECTIONS
7040 @{
7041 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7042 @}
7043 @end smallexample
7044 @noindent
7045 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7046 @samp{.data} section.
7047
7048 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7049 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7050
7051 @node Builtin Functions
7052 @subsection Builtin Functions
7053 @cindex functions in expressions
7054 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7055 use in linker script expressions.
7056
7057 @table @code
7058 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7059 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7060 @cindex expression, absolute
7061 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7062 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7063 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7064 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7065
7066 @item ADDR(@var{section})
7067 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7068 @cindex section address in expression
7069 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
7070 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7071 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7072 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7073 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7074 the other two will be absolute:
7075 @smallexample
7076 @group
7077 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7078 .output1 :
7079 @{
7080 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7081 @dots{}
7082 @}
7083 .output :
7084 @{
7085 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7086 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7087 @}
7088 @dots{} @}
7089 @end group
7090 @end smallexample
7091
7092 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
7093 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7094 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7095 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7096 @cindex round up location counter
7097 @cindex align location counter
7098 @cindex round up expression
7099 @cindex align expression
7100 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7101 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7102 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7103 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7104 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
7105 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
7106
7107 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7108 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7109 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7110 input sections:
7111 @smallexample
7112 @group
7113 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7114 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7115 *(.data)
7116 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7117 @}
7118 @dots{} @}
7119 @end group
7120 @end smallexample
7121 @noindent
7122 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7123 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7124 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7125 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7126
7127 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7128
7129 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7130 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7131 @cindex section alignment
7132 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7133 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7134 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7135 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7136 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7137 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7138 example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7139 first value in that section.
7140 @smallexample
7141 @group
7142 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7143 .output @{
7144 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7145 @dots{}
7146 @}
7147 @dots{} @}
7148 @end group
7149 @end smallexample
7150
7151 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7152 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7153 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7154 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7155 section.
7156
7157 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7158 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7159 This is equivalent to either
7160 @smallexample
7161 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7162 @end smallexample
7163 or
7164 @smallexample
7165 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7166 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
7167 @end smallexample
7168 @noindent
7169 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7170 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7171 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7172 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7173 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7174 bytes in the on-disk file.
7175
7176 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7177 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7178 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
7179 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7180 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7181 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7182 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
7183
7184 @noindent
7185 Example:
7186 @smallexample
7187 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7188 @end smallexample
7189
7190 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7191 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7192 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7193 evaluation purposes.
7194
7195 @smallexample
7196 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7197 @end smallexample
7198
7199 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7200 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7201 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7202 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7203 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7204 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7205 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7206 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7207 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7208 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7209 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7210 section alignment.
7211
7212 @smallexample
7213 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7214 @end smallexample
7215
7216 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7217 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7218 @cindex symbol defaults
7219 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7220 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7221 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7222 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7223 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7224 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7225 existed, its value is preserved:
7226
7227 @smallexample
7228 @group
7229 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7230 .text : @{
7231 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7232 @dots{}
7233 @}
7234 @dots{}
7235 @}
7236 @end group
7237 @end smallexample
7238
7239 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7240 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7241 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7242
7243 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7244 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7245 @cindex section load address in expression
7246 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7247 Section LMA}).
7248
7249 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7250 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7251 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7252 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7253
7254 @kindex MAX
7255 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7256 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7257
7258 @kindex MIN
7259 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7260 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7261
7262 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7263 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7264 @cindex unallocated address, next
7265 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7266 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7267 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7268 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7269
7270 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7271 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7272 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7273
7274 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7275 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7276 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7277 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7278 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7279 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7280 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7281 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7282 name.
7283
7284 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7285 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7286 @cindex section size
7287 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7288 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7289 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7290 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7291 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7292 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7293 example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7294 values:
7295 @smallexample
7296 @group
7297 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7298 .output @{
7299 .start = . ;
7300 @dots{}
7301 .end = . ;
7302 @}
7303 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7304 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7305 @dots{} @}
7306 @end group
7307 @end smallexample
7308
7309 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7310 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7311 @cindex header size
7312 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7313 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7314 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7315 choose, to facilitate paging.
7316
7317 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7318 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7319 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7320 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7321 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7322 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7323 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7324 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7325 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7326 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7327 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7328 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7329 @end table
7330
7331 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7332 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7333 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7334 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7335 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7336 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7337 linker will report an error.
7338
7339 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7340
7341 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7342 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7343 commands.
7344
7345 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7346 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7347 read. This can affect archive searching.
7348
7349 @node Plugins
7350 @chapter Linker Plugins
7351
7352 @cindex plugins
7353 @cindex linker plugins
7354 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7355 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7356 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7357
7358 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7359 be added here later.
7360
7361 Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
7362 command line option. @xref{Options}.
7363
7364 @menu
7365 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7366 @end menu
7367
7368 @node libdep Plugin
7369 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7370 @cindex static library dependencies
7371 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7372 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7373 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7374 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7375 rose to ascendance.
7376
7377 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7378 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7379 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7380 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7381 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7382 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7383 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7384 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7385
7386 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7387 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7388 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7389 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7390 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7391 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7392 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7393 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7394 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7395
7396 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7397 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7398 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7399
7400 @smallexample
7401 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 @ifset GENERIC
7405 @node Machine Dependent
7406 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7407
7408 @cindex machine dependencies
7409 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7410 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7411 functionality are not listed.
7412
7413 @menu
7414 @ifset H8300
7415 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7416 @end ifset
7417 @ifset M68HC11
7418 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7419 @end ifset
7420 @ifset ARM
7421 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7422 @end ifset
7423 @ifset HPPA
7424 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7425 @end ifset
7426 @ifset M68K
7427 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7428 @end ifset
7429 @ifset MIPS
7430 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7431 @end ifset
7432 @ifset MMIX
7433 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7434 @end ifset
7435 @ifset MSP430
7436 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7437 @end ifset
7438 @ifset NDS32
7439 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7440 @end ifset
7441 @ifset NIOSII
7442 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7443 @end ifset
7444 @ifset POWERPC
7445 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7446 @end ifset
7447 @ifset POWERPC64
7448 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7449 @end ifset
7450 @ifset S/390
7451 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7452 @end ifset
7453 @ifset SPU
7454 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7455 @end ifset
7456 @ifset TICOFF
7457 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7458 @end ifset
7459 @ifset WIN32
7460 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7461 @end ifset
7462 @ifset XTENSA
7463 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7464 @end ifset
7465 @end menu
7466 @end ifset
7467
7468 @ifset H8300
7469 @ifclear GENERIC
7470 @raisesections
7471 @end ifclear
7472
7473 @node H8/300
7474 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7475
7476 @cindex H8/300 support
7477 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7478 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7479
7480 @table @emph
7481 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7482 @item relaxing address modes
7483 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7484 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7485 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7486 respectively.
7487
7488 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7489 @item synthesizing instructions
7490 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7491 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7492 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7493 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7494 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7495 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7496 top page of memory).
7497
7498 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7499 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7500 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7501 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7502 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7503 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7504 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7505
7506 @item bit manipulation instructions
7507 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7508 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7509 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7510 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7511 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7512 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7513 the top page of memory).
7514
7515 @item system control instructions
7516 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7517 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7518 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7519 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7520 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7521 the top page of memory).
7522 @end table
7523
7524 @ifclear GENERIC
7525 @lowersections
7526 @end ifclear
7527 @end ifset
7528
7529 @ifclear GENERIC
7530 @ifset Renesas
7531 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7532 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7533 @node Renesas
7534 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7535
7536 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7537 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7538 options are required for these chips.
7539 @end ifset
7540 @end ifclear
7541
7542 @ifset ARM
7543 @ifclear GENERIC
7544 @raisesections
7545 @end ifclear
7546
7547 @ifset M68HC11
7548 @ifclear GENERIC
7549 @raisesections
7550 @end ifclear
7551
7552 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7553 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7554
7555 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7556
7557 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7558
7559 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7560 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7561
7562 @table @emph
7563 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7564 @item relaxing address modes
7565 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7566 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7567 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7568 respectively.
7569
7570 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7571 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7572 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7573
7574 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7575 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7576 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7577 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7578 @code{bset} instructions.
7579
7580 @end table
7581
7582 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7583
7584 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7585 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7586 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7587 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7588 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7589 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7590 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7591 point to the function trampoline.
7592
7593 @ifclear GENERIC
7594 @lowersections
7595 @end ifclear
7596 @end ifset
7597
7598 @node ARM
7599 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7600
7601 @cindex ARM interworking support
7602 @kindex --support-old-code
7603 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7604 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7605 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7606 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7607 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7608 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7609 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7610 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7611 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7612 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7613
7614 @cindex thumb entry point
7615 @cindex entry point, thumb
7616 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7617 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7618 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7619 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7620 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7621 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7622
7623 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7624 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7625 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7626 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7627 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7628 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7629
7630 @cindex BE8
7631 @kindex --be8
7632 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7633 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7634 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7635 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7636 little-endian code.
7637
7638 @cindex TARGET1
7639 @kindex --target1-rel
7640 @kindex --target1-abs
7641 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7642 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7643 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7644 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7645
7646 @cindex TARGET2
7647 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7648 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7649 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7650 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7651 @table @samp
7652 @item rel
7653 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7654 @item abs
7655 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7656 @item got-rel
7657 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7661 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7662 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7663 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7664 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7665 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7666
7667 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7668 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7669 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7670
7671 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7672 relocations are ignored.
7673
7674 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7675 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7676 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7677 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 TST rM, #1
7681 MOVEQ PC, rM
7682 BX Rn
7683 @end smallexample
7684
7685 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7686 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7687 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7688
7689 @cindex USE_BLX
7690 @kindex --use-blx
7691 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7692 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7693 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7694 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7695 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7696
7697 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7698 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7699 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7700 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7701 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7702 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7703 the support code can read the intended values.
7704
7705 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7706 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7707 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7708 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7709 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7710 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7711
7712 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7713 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7714 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7715 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7716 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7717 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7718
7719 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7720 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7721 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7722 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7723 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7724 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7725 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7726
7727 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7728 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7729 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7730 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7731 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7732 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7733 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7734
7735 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7736 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7737 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7738
7739 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7740 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7741
7742 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7743 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7744 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7745 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7746 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7747 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7748 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7749 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7750
7751 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7752 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7753
7754 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7755 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7756 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7757 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7758 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7759
7760 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7761 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7762 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7763 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7764 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7765 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7766
7767 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7768 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7769
7770 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7771 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7772 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7773 occurs.
7774
7775 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7776 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7777 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7778 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7779 occurs.
7780
7781 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7782 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7783 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7784 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7785 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7786 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7787 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7788 not be diagnosed.
7789
7790 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7791 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7792 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7793 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7794 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7795 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7796 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7797
7798 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7799 @kindex --pic-veneer
7800 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7801 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7802 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7803 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7804
7805 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7806 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7807 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7808 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7809 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7810 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7811 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7812 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7813 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7814 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7815 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7816 where they should be placed.
7817
7818 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7819 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7820 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7821 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7822 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7823 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7824 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7825 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7826 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7827 from the input sections.
7828
7829 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7830 @samp{N = +1}.
7831
7832 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7833 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7834 otherwise.
7835
7836 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7837 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7838 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7839 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7840
7841 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7842
7843 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7844 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7845 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7846 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7847
7848 Please contact ARM for further details.
7849
7850 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7851 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7852 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7853 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7854
7855 @kindex --long-plt
7856 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7857 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7858 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7859 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7860
7861 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7862 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7863 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7864 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7865
7866 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7867 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7868 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7869 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7870 veneers in memory.
7871
7872 @kindex --cmse-implib
7873 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7874 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7875 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7876 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7877 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7878
7879 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7880 @cindex Input import library
7881 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7882 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7883 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7884 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7885 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7886 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7887 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7888 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7889 specified.
7890
7891 @ifclear GENERIC
7892 @lowersections
7893 @end ifclear
7894 @end ifset
7895
7896 @ifset HPPA
7897 @ifclear GENERIC
7898 @raisesections
7899 @end ifclear
7900
7901 @node HPPA ELF32
7902 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7903 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7904 @kindex --multi-subspace
7905 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7906 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7907 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7908 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7909 multiple sub-spaces.
7910
7911 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7912 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7913 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7914 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7915 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7916 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7917 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7918 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7919 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7920 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7921 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7922 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7923 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7924 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7925 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7926 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7927
7928 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7929 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7930 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7931 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7932
7933 @ifclear GENERIC
7934 @lowersections
7935 @end ifclear
7936 @end ifset
7937
7938 @ifset M68K
7939 @ifclear GENERIC
7940 @raisesections
7941 @end ifclear
7942
7943 @node M68K
7944 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7945
7946 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7947 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7948 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7949 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7950 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7951 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7952 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7953 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7954 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7955 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7956 support such GOTs.
7957 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7958 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7959 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7960 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7961
7962 @ifclear GENERIC
7963 @lowersections
7964 @end ifclear
7965 @end ifset
7966
7967 @ifset MIPS
7968 @ifclear GENERIC
7969 @raisesections
7970 @end ifclear
7971
7972 @node MIPS
7973 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7974
7975 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7976 @kindex --insn32
7977 @kindex --no-insn32
7978 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7979 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7980 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7981 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7982 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7983 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7984
7985 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7986 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7987 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7988 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7989 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7990 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7991 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7992 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7993 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7994 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7995 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7996 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7997
7998 @ifclear GENERIC
7999 @lowersections
8000 @end ifclear
8001 @end ifset
8002
8003 @ifset MMIX
8004 @ifclear GENERIC
8005 @raisesections
8006 @end ifclear
8007
8008 @node MMIX
8009 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
8010 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8011 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8012 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8013 can translate between the two formats.
8014
8015 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8016 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8017 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8018 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8019 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8020 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8021 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8022 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8023
8024 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8025 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8026 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8027 of a section.
8028
8029 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8030 are left out from an mmo file.
8031
8032 @ifclear GENERIC
8033 @lowersections
8034 @end ifclear
8035 @end ifset
8036
8037 @ifset MSP430
8038 @ifclear GENERIC
8039 @raisesections
8040 @end ifclear
8041
8042 @node MSP430
8043 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
8044 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8045 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8046 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8047
8048 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
8049 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8050
8051 @table @code
8052 @item @samp{.vectors}
8053 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8054
8055 @item @samp{.bootloader}
8056 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8057 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8058
8059 @item @samp{.infomem}
8060 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8061 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8062
8063 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
8064 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8065 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8066
8067 @item @samp{.noinit}
8068 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8069
8070 The last two sections are used by gcc.
8071 @end table
8072
8073 @table @option
8074 @cindex MSP430 Options
8075 @kindex --code-region
8076 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8077 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8078 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8079 using this option.
8080
8081 @kindex --data-region
8082 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8083 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8084 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8085 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8086
8087 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8088 @item --disable-sec-transformation
8089 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8090 and @code{--data-region} options.
8091 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8092 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8093 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8094 @end table
8095
8096 @ifclear GENERIC
8097 @lowersections
8098 @end ifclear
8099 @end ifset
8100
8101 @ifset NDS32
8102 @ifclear GENERIC
8103 @raisesections
8104 @end ifclear
8105
8106 @node NDS32
8107 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
8108 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
8109 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8110 relaxes objects according to these options.
8111
8112 @table @code
8113 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8114 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8115
8116 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8117 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8118
8119 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8120 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8121
8122 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8123 Export the EX9 table after linking.
8124
8125 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8126 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8127
8128 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8129 Update the existing EX9 table.
8130
8131 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8132 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8133
8134 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8135 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8136
8137 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8138 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8139
8140 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8141 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8142 @end table
8143
8144 @ifclear GENERIC
8145 @lowersections
8146 @end ifclear
8147 @end ifset
8148
8149 @ifset NIOSII
8150 @ifclear GENERIC
8151 @raisesections
8152 @end ifclear
8153
8154 @node Nios II
8155 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8156 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
8157 @kindex --relax on Nios II
8158
8159 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8160 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8161 which may result in @command{ld} giving
8162 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8163 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8164 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8165 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8166 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8167 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8168 larger than 256MB.
8169
8170 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8171 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8172 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8173 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8174 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8175 register as a temporary.
8176
8177 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8178 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8179 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8180
8181 @ifclear GENERIC
8182 @lowersections
8183 @end ifclear
8184 @end ifset
8185
8186 @ifset POWERPC
8187 @ifclear GENERIC
8188 @raisesections
8189 @end ifclear
8190
8191 @node PowerPC ELF32
8192 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8193 @cindex PowerPC long branches
8194 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8195 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8196 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8197 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8198 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8199 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8200 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8201 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8202 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8203 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8204 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8205
8206 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8207 @table @option
8208 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8209 @kindex --bss-plt
8210 @item --bss-plt
8211 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8212 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8213 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8214 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8215 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8216 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8217 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8218 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8219
8220 @kindex --secure-plt
8221 @item --secure-plt
8222 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8223 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8224 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8225 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8226 style BSS PLT.
8227
8228 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8229 @kindex --sdata-got
8230 @item --sdata-got
8231 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8232 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8233 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8234 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8235 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8236 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8237 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8238 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8239 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8240 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8241 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8242 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8243
8244 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8245 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8246 @item --emit-stub-syms
8247 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8248 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8249
8250 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8251 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8252 @item --no-tls-optimize
8253 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8254 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8255 disable the optimization.
8256 @end table
8257
8258 @ifclear GENERIC
8259 @lowersections
8260 @end ifclear
8261 @end ifset
8262
8263 @ifset POWERPC64
8264 @ifclear GENERIC
8265 @raisesections
8266 @end ifclear
8267
8268 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8269 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8270
8271 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8272 @table @option
8273 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8274 @kindex --stub-group-size
8275 @item --stub-group-size
8276 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8277 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8278 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8279 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8280 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8281 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8282 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8283 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8284 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8285 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8286 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8287 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8288 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8289 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8290
8291 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8292 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8293 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8294 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8295
8296 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8297 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8298 @item --emit-stub-syms
8299 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8300 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8301
8302 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8303 @kindex --dotsyms
8304 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8305 @item --dotsyms
8306 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8307 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8308 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8309 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8310 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8311 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8312 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8313 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8314 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8315 feature.
8316
8317 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8318 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8319 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8320 @item --save-restore-funcs
8321 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8322 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8323 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8324 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8325 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8326 link.
8327
8328 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8329 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8330 @item --no-tls-optimize
8331 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8332 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8333 disable the optimization.
8334
8335 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8336 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8337 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8338 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8339 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8340 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8341 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8342 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8343 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8344 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8345 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8346 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8347 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8348 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8349 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8350 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8351 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8352 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8353 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8354 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8355 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8356 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8357 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8358 register saves.
8359
8360 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8361 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8362 @item --no-opd-optimize
8363 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8364 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8365 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8366 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8367
8368 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8369 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8370 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8371 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8372 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8373 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8374 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8375
8376 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8377 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8378 @item --no-toc-optimize
8379 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8380 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8381 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8382 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8383 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8384 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8385 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8386 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8387 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8388 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8389 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8390 optimization.
8391
8392 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8393 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8394 @item --no-inline-optimize
8395 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8396 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8397 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8398 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8399 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8400 disables that optimization.
8401
8402 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8403 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8404 @item --no-multi-toc
8405 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8406 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8407 where TOC
8408 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8409 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8410 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8411 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8412 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8413 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8414 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8415 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8416
8417 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8418 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8419 @item --no-toc-sort
8420 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8421 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8422 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8423 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8424 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8425 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8426 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8427 off this feature.
8428
8429 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8430 @kindex --plt-align
8431 @kindex --no-plt-align
8432 @item --plt-align
8433 @itemx --no-plt-align
8434 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8435 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8436 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8437 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8438 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8439 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8440 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8441
8442 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8443 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8444 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8445 @item --plt-static-chain
8446 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8447 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8448 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8449 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8450
8451 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8452 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8453 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8454 @item --plt-thread-safe
8455 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8456 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8457 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8458 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8459 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8460 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8461 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8462 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8463 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8464 default behaviour.
8465
8466 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8467 @kindex --plt-localentry
8468 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8469 @item --plt-localentry
8470 @itemx --no-localentry
8471 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8472 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8473 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8474 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8475 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8476 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8477 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8478 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8479 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8480 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8481 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8482 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8483
8484 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8485 @kindex --power10-stubs
8486 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8487 @item --power10-stubs
8488 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8489 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8490 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8491 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8492 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8493 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8494 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8495 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8496 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8497 auto mode.
8498 @end table
8499
8500 @ifclear GENERIC
8501 @lowersections
8502 @end ifclear
8503 @end ifset
8504
8505 @ifset S/390
8506 @ifclear GENERIC
8507 @raisesections
8508 @end ifclear
8509
8510 @node S/390 ELF
8511 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8512
8513 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8514 @table @option
8515
8516 @cindex S/390
8517 @kindex --s390-pgste
8518 @item --s390-pgste
8519 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8520 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8521 binaries marked that way.
8522 @end table
8523
8524 @ifclear GENERIC
8525 @lowersections
8526 @end ifclear
8527 @end ifset
8528
8529 @ifset SPU
8530 @ifclear GENERIC
8531 @raisesections
8532 @end ifclear
8533
8534 @node SPU ELF
8535 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8536
8537 @cindex SPU ELF options
8538 @table @option
8539
8540 @cindex SPU plugins
8541 @kindex --plugin
8542 @item --plugin
8543 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8544
8545 @cindex SPU overlays
8546 @kindex --no-overlays
8547 @item --no-overlays
8548 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8549 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8550 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8551 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8552
8553 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8554 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8555 @item --emit-stub-syms
8556 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8557 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8558
8559 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8560 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8561 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8562 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8563 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8564 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8565
8566 @cindex SPU local store size
8567 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8568 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8569 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8570 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8571 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8572
8573 @cindex SPU
8574 @kindex --stack-analysis
8575 @item --stack-analysis
8576 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8577 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8578 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8579 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8580 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8581 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8582 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8583 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8584 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8585 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8586 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8587 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8588 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8589 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8590 and calls will be given.
8591
8592 @cindex SPU
8593 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8594 @item --emit-stack-syms
8595 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8596 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8597 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8598 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8599 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8600 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8601 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8602 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8603 @end table
8604
8605 @ifclear GENERIC
8606 @lowersections
8607 @end ifclear
8608 @end ifset
8609
8610 @ifset TICOFF
8611 @ifclear GENERIC
8612 @raisesections
8613 @end ifclear
8614
8615 @node TI COFF
8616 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8617 @cindex TI COFF versions
8618 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8619 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8620 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8621 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8622 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8623 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8624
8625 @ifclear GENERIC
8626 @lowersections
8627 @end ifclear
8628 @end ifset
8629
8630 @ifset WIN32
8631 @ifclear GENERIC
8632 @raisesections
8633 @end ifclear
8634
8635 @node WIN32
8636 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8637
8638 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8639 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8640 command-line options mentioned here.
8641
8642 @table @emph
8643 @cindex import libraries
8644 @item import libraries
8645 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8646 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8647 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8648 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8649 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8650 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8651
8652 @item Resource only DLLs
8653 It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8654 @samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8655 must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
8656 will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
8657 there is no input to go into them.
8658
8659 The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8660 should be changed to match the desired format.
8661
8662 @example
8663 OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8664 SECTIONS
8665 @{
8666 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8667 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8668 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8669 @{
8670 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8671 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8672 @}
8673 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8674 @}
8675 @end example
8676
8677 With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8678 line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8679 @file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8680
8681 @smallexample
8682 ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8683 @end smallexample
8684
8685 @item exporting DLL symbols
8686 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8687 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8688
8689 @table @emph
8690 @item using auto-export functionality
8691 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8692 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8693 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8694
8695 @itemize
8696 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8697 @item --exclude-symbols
8698 @item --exclude-libs
8699 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8700 @item --version-script
8701 @end itemize
8702
8703 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8704 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8705 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8706 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8707 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8708 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8709 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8710 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8711
8712 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8713 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8714 if either of the following are true:
8715
8716 @itemize
8717 @item A DEF file is used.
8718 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8719 @end itemize
8720
8721 @item using a DEF file
8722 @cindex using a DEF file
8723 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8724 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8725 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8726 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8727 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8728
8729 @example
8730 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8731 @end example
8732
8733 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8734 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8735
8736 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8737
8738 @example
8739 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8740
8741 EXPORTS
8742 foo
8743 bar
8744 _bar = bar
8745 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8746 var1 DATA
8747 doo = foo == foo2
8748 eoo DATA == var1
8749 @end example
8750
8751 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8752 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8753 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8754 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8755 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8756 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8757 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8758 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8759 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8760
8761 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8762 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8763 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8764
8765 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8766 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8767 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8768 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8769
8770 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8771 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8772 non-default base address for the image.
8773
8774 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8775 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8776 filename specified on the command line.
8777
8778 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8779
8780 @example
8781 EXPORTS
8782 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8783 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8784 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8785 @end example
8786
8787 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8788 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8789 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8790 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8791 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8792 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8793 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8794
8795 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8796
8797 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8798 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8799 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8800 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8801 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8802
8803 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8804 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8805 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8806 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8807
8808 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8809 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8810 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8811 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8812 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8813 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8814 application will behave unexpectedly.
8815
8816 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8817 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8818 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8819 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8820 the DLL without an import library.
8821
8822 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8823 other DEF file statements
8824
8825 @cindex creating a DEF file
8826 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8827 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8828
8829 @item Using decorations
8830 @cindex Using decorations
8831 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8832 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8833 declared as:
8834
8835 @example
8836 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8837 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8838 @end example
8839
8840 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8841 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8842 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8843 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8844
8845 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8846 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8847 instead:
8848
8849 @example
8850 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8851 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8852 @end example
8853
8854 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8855 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8856 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8857 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8858 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8859 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8860 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8861 information.
8862 @end table
8863
8864 @cindex automatic data imports
8865 @item automatic data imports
8866 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8867 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8868 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8869 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8870 code to these platforms, especially for large
8871 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8872 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8873 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8874 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8875 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8876 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8877 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8878 trigger the feature's use.
8879
8880 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8881 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8882
8883 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8884 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8885
8886 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8887 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8888 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8889 below.
8890
8891 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8892 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8893 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8894 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8895 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8896 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8897 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8898 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8899 references.
8900
8901 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8902 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8903 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8904 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8905 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8906 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8907 run without error on an older system.
8908
8909 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8910 enabled as needed.
8911
8912 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8913 @item direct linking to a dll
8914 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8915 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8916 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8917 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8918 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8919 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8920 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8921 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8922 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8923 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8924
8925 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8926 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8927 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8928 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8929 select the dll instead of an import library.
8930
8931
8932 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8933 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8934
8935 @example
8936 libxxx.dll.a
8937 xxx.dll.a
8938 libxxx.a
8939 xxx.lib
8940 libxxx.lib
8941 cygxxx.dll (*)
8942 libxxx.dll
8943 xxx.dll
8944 @end example
8945
8946 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8947
8948 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8949 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8950 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8951 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8952 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8953
8954 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8955 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8956 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8957 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8958 could coexist on the same machine.
8959
8960 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8961 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8962 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8963
8964 @example
8965 bin/
8966 cygxxx.dll
8967 lib/
8968 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8969 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8970 @end example
8971
8972 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8973 done two ways:
8974
8975 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8976 @example
8977 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8978 @end example
8979
8980 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8981 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8982 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8983 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8984
8985 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8986 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8987 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8988 making the app/dll.
8989
8990 @example
8991 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8992 @end example
8993
8994 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8995
8996 @example
8997 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8998 @end example
8999
9000 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
9001 perfectly legal
9002
9003 @example
9004 bin/
9005 cygxxx-5.dll
9006 lib/
9007 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
9008 @end example
9009
9010 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
9011 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9012 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9013
9014 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
9015 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
9016
9017 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9018 work with auto-imported data.
9019
9020 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9021 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9022 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9023 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9024 possible to do this without an import lib.
9025
9026 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9027 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9028 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9029 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9030
9031 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
9032 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9033 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9034 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
9035 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9036 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9037 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
9038
9039 @item symbol aliasing
9040 @table @emph
9041 @item adding additional names
9042 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
9043 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9044 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9045 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
9046 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
9047
9048 @example
9049 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9050
9051 EXPORTS
9052 foo
9053 _foo = foo
9054 @end example
9055
9056 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9057
9058 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9059 source code using the "weak" attribute:
9060
9061 @example
9062 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
9063 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
9064 @end example
9065
9066 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9067 symbols.
9068
9069 @item renaming symbols
9070 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
9071 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
9072 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9073 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
9074 created). In the following example:
9075
9076 @example
9077 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9078
9079 EXPORTS
9080 _foo = foo
9081 @end example
9082
9083 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9084 @samp{_foo}.
9085 @end table
9086
9087 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
9088 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
9089 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
9090 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9091 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9092 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9093 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9094 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9095 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9096 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
9097 which is probably not what you wanted.
9098
9099 @cindex weak externals
9100 @item weak externals
9101 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9102 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9103 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9104 are three variants of weak externals:
9105 @itemize
9106 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9107 called lazy externals.
9108 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9109 This form is not presently implemented.
9110 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9111 implemented.
9112 @end itemize
9113 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9114 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9115 uses a default value.
9116
9117 @cindex aligned common symbols
9118 @item aligned common symbols
9119 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9120 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9121 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9122 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9123 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9124 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9125 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9126 warnings about unknown linker directives.
9127
9128 @end table
9129
9130 @ifclear GENERIC
9131 @lowersections
9132 @end ifclear
9133 @end ifset
9134
9135 @ifset XTENSA
9136 @ifclear GENERIC
9137 @raisesections
9138 @end ifclear
9139
9140 @node Xtensa
9141 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9142
9143 @cindex Xtensa processors
9144 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9145 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9146 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9147 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9148 example, with the command:
9149
9150 @smallexample
9151 SECTIONS
9152 @{
9153 .text : @{
9154 *(.literal .text)
9155 @}
9156 @}
9157 @end smallexample
9158
9159 @noindent
9160 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9161 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9162 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9163 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9164 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9165 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9166 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
9167
9168 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
9169 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
9170 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9171 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9172 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9173 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9174 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9175 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9176 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9177 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9178 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9179 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9180
9181 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9182 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9183 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9184 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9185 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9186 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9187 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9188 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9189 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9190 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9191 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9192 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9193 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9194 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9195
9196 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9197 control the linker:
9198
9199 @cindex Xtensa options
9200 @table @option
9201 @item --size-opt
9202 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9203 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9204 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9205 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9206 preserve the correctness of the code.
9207
9208 @item --abi-windowed
9209 @itemx --abi-call0
9210 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9211 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9212 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9213 conventions.
9214 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9215 of the first input object.
9216 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9217 or the chosen output object ABI.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 @ifclear GENERIC
9221 @lowersections
9222 @end ifclear
9223 @end ifset
9224
9225 @ifclear SingleFormat
9226 @node BFD
9227 @chapter BFD
9228
9229 @cindex back end
9230 @cindex object file management
9231 @cindex object formats available
9232 @kindex objdump -i
9233 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9234 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9235 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9236 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9237 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9238 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9239 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9240 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9241 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9242
9243 @cindex BFD requirements
9244 @cindex requirements for BFD
9245 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9246 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9247 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9248 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9249 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9250 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9251 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9252
9253 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9254 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9255 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9256 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9257
9258 @menu
9259 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9260 @end menu
9261
9262 @node BFD outline
9263 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9264 @cindex opening object files
9265 @include bfdsumm.texi
9266 @end ifclear
9267
9268 @node Reporting Bugs
9269 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9270 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9271 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9272
9273 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9274
9275 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9276 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9277 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9278 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9279 @command{ld}.
9280
9281 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9282 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9283
9284 @menu
9285 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9286 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9287 @end menu
9288
9289 @node Bug Criteria
9290 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9291 @cindex bug criteria
9292
9293 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9294
9295 @itemize @bullet
9296 @cindex fatal signal
9297 @cindex linker crash
9298 @cindex crash of linker
9299 @item
9300 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9301 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9302
9303 @cindex error on valid input
9304 @item
9305 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9306
9307 @cindex invalid input
9308 @item
9309 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9310 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9311 object files are correct.
9312
9313 @item
9314 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9315 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9316 @end itemize
9317
9318 @node Bug Reporting
9319 @section How to Report Bugs
9320 @cindex bug reports
9321 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9322
9323 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9324 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9325 recommend you contact that organization first.
9326
9327 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9328 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9329 distribution.
9330
9331 @ifset BUGURL
9332 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9333 @value{BUGURL}.
9334 @end ifset
9335
9336 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9337 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9338 fact or leave it out, state it!
9339
9340 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9341 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9342 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9343 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9344 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9345 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9346 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9347 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9348 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9349 and the most helpful.
9350
9351 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9352 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9353 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9354
9355 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9356 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9357 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9358 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9359
9360 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9361
9362 @itemize @bullet
9363 @item
9364 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9365 the @samp{--version} argument.
9366
9367 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9368 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9369
9370 @item
9371 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9372 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9373
9374 @item
9375 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9376 version number.
9377
9378 @item
9379 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9380 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9381
9382 @item
9383 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9384 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9385 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9386 sufficient.
9387
9388 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9389 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9390
9391 @item
9392 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9393 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9394 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9395 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9396 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9397 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9398 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9399 attachments are best.
9400
9401 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9402 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9403 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9404 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9405 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9406
9407 @item
9408 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9409 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9410
9411 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9412 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9413 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9414 a chance to make a mistake.
9415
9416 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9417 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9418 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9419 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9420 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9421 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9422 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9423 any conclusion from our observations.
9424
9425 @item
9426 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9427 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9428 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9429 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9430 context, not by line number.
9431
9432 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9433 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9434 @end itemize
9435
9436 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9437
9438 @itemize @bullet
9439 @item
9440 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9441
9442 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9443 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9444 changes will not affect it.
9445
9446 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9447 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9448 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9449 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9450
9451 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9452 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9453 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9454 less time, and so on.
9455
9456 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9457 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9458
9459 @item
9460 A patch for the bug.
9461
9462 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9463 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9464 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9465 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9466
9467 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9468 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9469 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9470 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9471 fixed.
9472
9473 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9474 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9475 help us to understand.
9476
9477 @item
9478 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9479
9480 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9481 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9482 @end itemize
9483
9484 @node MRI
9485 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9486 @cindex MRI compatibility
9487 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9488 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9489 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9490 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9491 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9492 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9493 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9494
9495 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9496 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9497 features to make use of them.
9498
9499 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9500 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9501
9502 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9503 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9504 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9505 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9506 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9507
9508 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9509
9510 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9511 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9512 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9513
9514 @table @code
9515 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9516 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9517 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9518 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9519 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9520 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9521 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9522 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9523 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9524 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9525 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9526
9527 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9528 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9529 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9530 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9531
9532 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9533
9534 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9535 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9536 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9537 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9538
9539 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9540 @item BASE @var{expression}
9541 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9542 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9543
9544 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9545 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9546 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9547 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9548
9549 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9550 @item END
9551 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9552
9553 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9554 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9555 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9556 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9557
9558 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9559 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9560 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9561 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9562
9563 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9564 same line, with no change in its effect.
9565
9566 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9567 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9568 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9569 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9570 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9571 command line.
9572
9573 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9574 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9575 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9576 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9577 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9578
9579 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9580 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9581 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9582 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9583 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9584 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9585 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9586 file, in the order specified.
9587
9588 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9589 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9590 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9591 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9592 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9593 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9594
9595 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9596 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9597 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9598 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9599 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9600 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9601 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9602 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9603 @end table
9604
9605 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9606 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9607 @include fdl.texi
9608
9609 @node LD Index
9610 @unnumbered LD Index
9611
9612 @printindex cp
9613
9614 @tex
9615 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9616 % meantime:
9617 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9618 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9619 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9620 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9621 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9622 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9623 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9624 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9625 \page\colophon
9626 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9627 @end tex
9628
9629 @bye